blob: 862fa72d4711b005bb04df927af9d6e57d735c7d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100676. Cache
686.1. Limitation
696.2. Setup
706.2.1. Cache section
716.2.2. Proxy section
72
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
747.1. ACL basics
757.1.1. Matching booleans
767.1.2. Matching integers
777.1.3. Matching strings
787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
827.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200837.3.1. Converters
847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200897.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090
918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100601 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200603 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200605 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100608 - presetenv
609 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - uid
611 - ulimit-n
612 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200613 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200615 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200617 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200618 - ssl-default-bind-options
619 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200620 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200621 - ssl-default-server-options
622 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100623 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100624 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100625 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100626 - 51degrees-data-file
627 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200628 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200629 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200630 - wurfl-data-file
631 - wurfl-information-list
632 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200633 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100634 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100637 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200638 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200640 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100641 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100642 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100643 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200644 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200645 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200646 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200647 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - noepoll
649 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000650 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300653 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000654 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100655 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200656 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200657 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200658 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000659 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000660 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200661 - tune.buffers.limit
662 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200663 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200664 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100665 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200666 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200667 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200668 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100669 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200670 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200671 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100672 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100673 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100674 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100675 - tune.lua.session-timeout
676 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200677 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100678 - tune.maxaccept
679 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200680 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200681 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200682 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100683 - tune.rcvbuf.client
684 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100685 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200686 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100687 - tune.sndbuf.client
688 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100689 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100690 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200691 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100692 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200693 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200694 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100695 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200696 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100697 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200698 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
699 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
700 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100701 - tune.zlib.memlevel
702 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704 * Debugging
705 - debug
706 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710------------------------------------
711
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200712ca-base <dir>
713 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200714 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
715 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717chroot <jail dir>
718 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
719 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
720 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
721 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
722 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100724
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100725cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
726 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
727 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
728 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
729 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
730 set. These sets have the format
731
732 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
733
734 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
737 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100738 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
739 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100741 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100743 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
745 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
746 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
747 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100748
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100749 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
750 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
751 on the machine's word size.
752
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100753 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
755 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
756 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
757 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
758 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
759 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100760
761 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100762 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
763
764 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
765 # first 4 CPUs
766
767 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
768 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
769 # word size.
770
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100772 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100773 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
774 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
775 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
776
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
778 # and so on.
779 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100783 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
785 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
786 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
787
788 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
790 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
791
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100792 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
793 # and a thread range.
794 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
797
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200798crt-base <dir>
799 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
800 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
801 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200803daemon
804 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
805 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100806 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
807 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200809deviceatlas-json-file <path>
810 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100811 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200812
813deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100814 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
816
817deviceatlas-separator <char>
818 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
819 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
820
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100821deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200822 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
823 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
824 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100825
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100827 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
828 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100829 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
830 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
831 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
832 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
833 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900834
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200835gid <number>
836 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
837 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
838 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100839 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
840 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100842
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100843group <group name>
844 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
845 See also "gid" and "user".
846
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100847hard-stop-after <time>
848 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
849
850 Arguments :
851 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
852 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
853 SIGUSR1 signal.
854
855 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
856 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
857 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
858
859 Example:
860 global
861 hard-stop-after 30s
862
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200863h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
864 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
865 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
866 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
867 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
868 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
869 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
870 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
871 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
872 specified in a proxy.
873
874 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
875 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
876 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
877 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
878 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
879 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
880 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
881
882 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
883 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
884 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
885 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
886 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
887
888 Example:
889 global
890 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
891
892 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
893 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
894
895h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
896 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
897 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
898 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
899 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
900 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
901 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
902 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
903 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
904
905 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
906 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
907 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
908
909 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
910 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
911
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100912insecure-fork-wanted
913 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
914 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
915 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
916 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
917 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
918 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
919 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
920 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
921 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
922 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
923 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
924 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
925 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
926 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
927 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
928 disable it.
929
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100930insecure-setuid-wanted
931 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
932 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
933 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
934 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
935 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
936 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
937 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
938 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
939 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
940 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
941 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
942 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
943 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
944 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
945
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200946log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
947 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100948 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100949 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100950 configured with "log global".
951
952 <address> can be one of:
953
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100954 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100955 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
956 port).
957
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100958 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
959 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
960 port).
961
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100962 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100963 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
964 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100965 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100966
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100967 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
968 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
969 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
970 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
971 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
972 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
973 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
974 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
975 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
976 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
977 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
978 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
979 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
980 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100981 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
982 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100983
984 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
985 "fd@2", see above.
986
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200987 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
988 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
989 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
990 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
991 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
992
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200993 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
994 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100995
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200996 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
997 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
998 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
999 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1000 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1001 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1002 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1003 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1004 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1005 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001006 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1007 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001008
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001009 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1010 one of the following :
1011
1012 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1013 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1014
1015 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1016 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1017
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001018 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1019 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1020 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1021 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1022 logger consumes.
1023
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001024 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1025 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1026 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1027 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1028
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001029 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1030 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1031 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1032 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1033 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1034
1035 <sample_size>
1036 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1037 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1038 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1039 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1040 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1041
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001042 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001044 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1045 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1046 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1049 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1050 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1051 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052
1053 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001054 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1055 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1056 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1057 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1058 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1059 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001061 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001063log-send-hostname [<string>]
1064 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1065 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1066 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1067 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1068 the logs.
1069
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001070log-tag <string>
1071 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1072 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1073 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001074 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001075
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001076lua-load <file>
1077 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1078 used multiple times.
1079
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001080master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001081 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1082 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1083 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001084 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001085 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1086 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001087 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1088 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1089 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1090 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1091 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001092
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001093 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001094
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001095mworker-max-reloads <number>
1096 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001097 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001098 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1099 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1100 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102nbproc <number>
1103 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1104 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1105 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001106 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1107 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001108 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1109 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001111nbthread <number>
1112 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001113 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1114 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1115 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1116 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1117 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001118 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1119 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1120 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1121 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1122 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1123 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1124 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001125
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001127 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1129 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1130
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001131presetenv <name> <value>
1132 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1133 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1134 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1135 and "unsetenv".
1136
1137resetenv [<name> ...]
1138 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1139 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1140 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1141 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1142 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1143 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1144 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1145 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1146
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001147stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001148 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1149 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1150 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1151 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1152 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1153 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001154 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001155 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1156 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1157 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1158 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001159
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001160server-state-base <directory>
1161 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001162 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1163 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001164
1165server-state-file <file>
1166 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1167 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1168 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1169 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1170 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1171 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1172 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1173 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001174 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1175 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001177setenv <name> <value>
1178 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1179 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1180 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1181 and "unsetenv".
1182
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001183set-dumpable
1184 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001185 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1186 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1187 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1188 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1189 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1190 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1191 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1192 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1193 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1194 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1195 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1196 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1197 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1198 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1199 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1200 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1201 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001202
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001203ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1205 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001206 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001207 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001208 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1209 information and recommendations see e.g.
1210 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1211 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1212 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1213 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001214
1215ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1217 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1218 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1219 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1220 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001221 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1222 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1223 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001224 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001225
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001226ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1228 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1229 keyword to see available options.
1230
1231 Example:
1232 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001233 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001234
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001235ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1237 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001238 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001239 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001240 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1241 information and recommendations see e.g.
1242 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1243 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1244 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1245 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1246 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001247
1248ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1250 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1251 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1252 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1253 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001254 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1255 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1256 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1257 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001258
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001259ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1261 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1262 keyword to see available options.
1263
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001264ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1266 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1267 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001269 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001270 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1271 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1272 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1273 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001274 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1275 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1276 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1277
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001278ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1279 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1280 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1281 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1282
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001283stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1284 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1285 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1286 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001287 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001288 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001289
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001290 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1291 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1292 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001293
1294stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1295 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1296 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001297 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001298
1299stats maxconn <connections>
1300 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1301 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303uid <number>
1304 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1305 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1306 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1307 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1308
1309ulimit-n <number>
1310 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1311 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1312 option.
1313
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001314unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1315 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1316
1317 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1318 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1319 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1320 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1321 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1322 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1323 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1324 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1325 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1326 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1327
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001328unsetenv [<name> ...]
1329 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1330 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1331 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1332 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1333 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1334 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1335 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337user <user name>
1338 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1339 See also "uid" and "group".
1340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001341node <name>
1342 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1343
1344 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1345 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1346 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1347 traffic.
1348
1349description <text>
1350 Add a text that describes the instance.
1351
1352 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1353 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1354 "<" and ">" characters.
1355
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100135651degrees-data-file <file path>
1357 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001358 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001359
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001360 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001361 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1362
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1365 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1366 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1367
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001368 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001369 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1370
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001372 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1373 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1374
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001375 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1376 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1377
137851degrees-cache-size <number>
1379 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1380 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1381 By default, this cache is disabled.
1382
1383 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001384 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1385
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386wurfl-data-file <file path>
1387 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1388 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1389
1390 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1391 with USE_WURFL=1.
1392
1393wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1394 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1395 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1396 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1397
1398 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1399
1400 Valid WURFL properties are:
1401 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1402
1403 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1404 device.
1405
1406 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1407 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1408
1409 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1410 particular web request.
1411
1412 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1413 used Libwurfl API version.
1414
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001415 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1416 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1417
1418 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1419 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1420
1421 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1422
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001423 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1424 with USE_WURFL=1.
1425
1426wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1427 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1428 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1429
1430 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1431 with USE_WURFL=1.
1432
1433wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1434 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1435 thus before the chroot.
1436
1437 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1438 with USE_WURFL=1.
1439
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001440wurfl-cache-size <size>
1441 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1442 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001443 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001444 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001445
1446 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1447 with USE_WURFL=1.
1448
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001449strict-limits
1450 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1451 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1452 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1453 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1454 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1455 keyword.
1456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001458-----------------------
1459
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001460busy-polling
1461 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1462 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1463 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1464 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1465 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1466 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1467 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1468 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1469 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1470 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1471 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1472 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1473 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1474 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1475 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1476 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1477 "poll" pollers.
1478
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001479max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1480 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1481 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1482 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1483 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1484 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1485 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1486 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1487 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001489maxconn <number>
1490 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1491 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1492 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001493 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1494 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1495 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1496 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001497 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1498 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1499 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1500 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1501 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1502 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001503
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001504maxconnrate <number>
1505 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1506 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1507 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1508 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1509 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1510 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1511 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1512 fairness.
1513
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001514maxcomprate <number>
1515 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001517 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1518 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1519 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001520 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001521 default value.
1522
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001523maxcompcpuusage <number>
1524 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1525 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1526 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1527 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1528 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1529 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1530 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1531 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1532
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001533maxpipes <number>
1534 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1535 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1536 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1537 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1538 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1539 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1540
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001541maxsessrate <number>
1542 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1543 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1544 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1545 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1546 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1547 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1548 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1549 fairness.
1550
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001551maxsslconn <number>
1552 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1553 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1554 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1555 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1556 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1557 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1558 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001559 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1560 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1561 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1562 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1563 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1564 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1565 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001566
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001567maxsslrate <number>
1568 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1569 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1570 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1571 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1572 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1573 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1574 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1575 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1576 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1577 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1578
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001579maxzlibmem <number>
1580 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1581 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1582 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001583 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1584 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1585 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1586
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001587noepoll
1588 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1589 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001590 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001591
1592nokqueue
1593 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1594 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1595 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1596
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001597noevports
1598 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1599 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1600 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1601 also "nopoll".
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603nopoll
1604 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1605 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001607 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1608 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001609
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001610nosplice
1611 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001612 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001613 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001614 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001615 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1616 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1617 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1618 "option splice-response".
1619
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001620nogetaddrinfo
1621 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1622 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1623
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001624noreuseport
1625 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1626 command line argument "-dR".
1627
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001628profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1629 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1630 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1631 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1632 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001633 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001634 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1635 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1636 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1637 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1638
1639 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1640 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1641 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1642 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1643 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001644 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1645 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1646 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1647 CLI.
1648
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001649spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001650 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1651 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1652 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1653 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1654 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1655 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001656
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001657ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001658 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001659 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001660 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1661 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1662 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1663 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1664 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001665 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1666 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001667 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1668 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1669 openssl configuration file uses:
1670 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1671
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001672ssl-mode-async
1673 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001674 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001675 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1676 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1677 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001678 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001679 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001680
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001681tune.buffers.limit <number>
1682 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1683 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1684 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1685 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1686 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001688 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1689 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1690 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1691 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1692 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1693 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1694 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1695 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1696 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1697
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001698tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1699 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1700 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1701 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1702 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1703
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001704tune.bufsize <number>
1705 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1706 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1707 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1708 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1709 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1710 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1711 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001712 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1713 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1714 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001715 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001716 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1717 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1718 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001719
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001720tune.chksize <number>
1721 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1722 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1723 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1724 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1725 checks whenever possible.
1726
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001727tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1728 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1729 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1730 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1731 this value. The default value is 1.
1732
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001733tune.fail-alloc
1734 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1735 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1736 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1737 gracefully.
1738
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001739tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1740 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1741 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1742 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1743 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1744 change it.
1745
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001746tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1747 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1749 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001750 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1751 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1752 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1753 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1754 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1755
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001756tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1757 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1758 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1759 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1760 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1761 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1762 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1763 recommended not to change this value.
1764
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001765tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1766 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1767 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1768 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1769 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1770 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1771 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1772 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1773
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001774tune.http.cookielen <number>
1775 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1776 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1777 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1778 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1779 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1780 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1781 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1782 to change this value.
1783
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001784tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001785 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1786 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001787 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001788 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001789 configuration directives too.
1790 The default value is 1024.
1791
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001792tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1793 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1794 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1795 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1796 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1797 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1798 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001799 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1800 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1801 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001802
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001803tune.idletimer <timeout>
1804 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1805 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1806 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1807 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1808 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1809 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001811 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001812 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1813
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001814tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1815 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1816 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1817 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1818 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1819 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1820 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1821 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1822 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1823 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1824
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001825tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1826 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001827 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001828 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1829 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001830 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001831 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1832 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1833
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001834tune.lua.maxmem
1835 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1836 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1837 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1838 memory.
1839
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001840tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1841 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001842 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1843 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001844 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001845
1846tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1847 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1848 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1849 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1850 check servers.
1851
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001852tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1853 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1854 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1855 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001856 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001857
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001858tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001859 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1860 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1861 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1862 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1863 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1864 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1865 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1866 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1867 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1868 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001869
1870tune.maxpollevents <number>
1871 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1872 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1873 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1874 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1875 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1876
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001877tune.maxrewrite <number>
1878 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1879 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1880 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1881 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1882 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1883 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1884 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1885 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1886 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1887 bufsize.
1888
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001889tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1890 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1891 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1892 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1893 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1894 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1895 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1896 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1897 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1898 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001899 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1900 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001901 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1902 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1903 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1904 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1905 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1906 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1907 setting this parameter to 0.
1908
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001909tune.pipesize <number>
1910 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1911 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1912 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1913 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1914 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1915 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1916
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001917tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1918 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1919 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1920 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1921 default is 20.
1922
1923tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1924 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1925 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1926 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1927 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1928 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1929 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001930 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001931
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001932tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1933tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1934 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1935 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1936 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001937 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001939 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1940 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1941
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001942tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001944 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1945 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1946 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1947 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1948
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001949tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001950 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001951 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1952 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1953
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001954tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1955tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1956 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1957 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1958 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001959 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001960 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001961 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1962 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1963 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1964 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1965 notifying haproxy again.
1966
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001967tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001968 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1969 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1970 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001971 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001972 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001973 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001974 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1975 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1976 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001977 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1978 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001979
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001980tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001981 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001982 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1983 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1984 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1985 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1986 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1987
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001988tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1989 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001990 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001991 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1992 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1993 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1994 being used for too long.
1995
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001996tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1997 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1998 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1999 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2000 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2001 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2002 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2003 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2004 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2005 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2006 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002007 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002008 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002009
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002010tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2011 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2012 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2013 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2014 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2015 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2016 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2017 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002018 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2019 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002020
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002021tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2022 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2023 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2024 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2025 1000 entries.
2026
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002027tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2028 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2029 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2030 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2031
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002032tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002033tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002034tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2035tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2036tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002037 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2038 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2039 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2040 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2041 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2042 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2043 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2044 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002045
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002046 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2047 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2048 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2049 all available space is consumed.
2050 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2051 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2052 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002053
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002054tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2055 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002056 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002057 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002059 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2060
2061tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2062 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2063 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002064 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2065 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020673.3. Debugging
2068--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002069
2070debug
2071 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2072 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2073 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2074 system startup.
2075
2076quiet
2077 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2078 line argument "-q".
2079
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020813.4. Userlists
2082--------------
2083It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2084http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2085it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2086
2087userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002088 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002089 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2090
2091group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002092 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002093 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2094 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2095
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002096user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2097 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002098 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2099 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002100 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2101 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2102 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2103 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002104
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002105 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2106 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2107 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2108 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2109 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2110 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2111 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2112 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2113 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002114
2115 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002116 userlist L1
2117 group G1 users tiger,scott
2118 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002119
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002120 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2121 user scott insecure-password elgato
2122 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002123
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002124 userlist L2
2125 group G1
2126 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2129 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2130 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002131
2132 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002133
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002134
21353.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002136----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002137It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2138several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2139instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2140values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2141automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2142In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2143using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2144tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2145reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2146Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2147that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2148each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002149
2150peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002151 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002152 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2153
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002154bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2155 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2156 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2157
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002158disabled
2159 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2160 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2161 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2162
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002163default-bind [param*]
2164 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2165
2166default-server [param*]
2167 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2168
2169 Arguments:
2170 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2171 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2172 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2173 details.
2174
2175
2176 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2177
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002178enable
2179 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2180
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002181log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2182 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2183 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2184 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2185 more details.
2186
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002187peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002188 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2189 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2190 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2191 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2192 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2193 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2194
2195 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2196 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2197
2198 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2199 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2200 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2201 across all peers.
2202
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002203 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2204 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002205
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002206 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2207 "server" keyword explanation below).
2208
2209server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002210 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002211 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2212 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2213 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2214 of this "peers" section).
2215 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2216
2217
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002218 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002219 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002220 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002221 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2222 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2223 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002224
2225 backend mybackend
2226 mode tcp
2227 balance roundrobin
2228 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2229 stick on src
2230
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002231 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2232 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002233
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002234 Example:
2235 peers mypeers
2236 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2237 default-server ssl verify none
2238 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2239 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002240
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002241
2242table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2243 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2244
2245 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2246 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002247 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002248 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2249 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2250 "stick-table" keyword).
2251
2252 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2253 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2254 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2255 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2256 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2257 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2258 of the stick-table name as follows:
2259
2260 peers mypeers
2261 peer A ...
2262 peer B ...
2263 table t1 ...
2264
2265 frontend fe1
2266 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2267
2268 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2269 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2270
2271 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2272 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2273 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2274 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2275 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2276 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2277 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2278
2279 peers mypeers
2280 peer A ...
2281 peer B ...
2282 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2283
2284 backend t1
2285 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2286
2287 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2288 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2289 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2290
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022913.6. Mailers
2292------------
2293It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2294If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2295in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2296
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002297mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002298 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2299 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2300
2301mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2302 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2303
2304 Example:
2305 mailers mymailers
2306 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2307 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2308
2309 backend mybackend
2310 mode tcp
2311 balance roundrobin
2312
2313 email-alert mailers mymailers
2314 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2315 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2316
2317 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2318 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2319
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002320timeout mail <time>
2321 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2322 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2323 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2324 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2325
2326 Example:
2327 mailers mymailers
2328 timeout mail 20s
2329 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002330
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023313.7. Programs
2332-------------
2333In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2334master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2335managed the same way as the workers.
2336
2337During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2338sequence as a worker:
2339
2340 - the master is re-executed
2341 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2342 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2343 instance of the program
2344
2345During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2346
2347program <name>
2348 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2349 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2350 the management guide).
2351
2352command <command> [arguments*]
2353 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2354 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2355 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2356 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2357
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002358user <user name>
2359 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2360 See also "group".
2361
2362group <group name>
2363 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2364 See also "user".
2365
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002366option start-on-reload
2367no option start-on-reload
2368 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2369 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2370 program section.
2371
2372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023734. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002374----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002376Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002377 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002378 - frontend <name>
2379 - backend <name>
2380 - listen <name>
2381
2382A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2383its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2384section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002386
2387A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2388connections.
2389
2390A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2391to forward incoming connections.
2392
2393A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2394parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2397'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2398case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2399
2400Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2401logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2402proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2403However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2404name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2405
2406Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2407and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002408bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2410modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2411arbitrary criteria.
2412
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002413In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2414a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002415the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002416
2417 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2418 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2419 between responses and new requests.
2420
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002421 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2422 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2423 client-facing connection remains open.
2424
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002425 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2426 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002427
2428The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2429frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2430following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002431weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002432
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002433 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002434
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002435 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2436 ----+-----+-----+----
2437 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2438 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002439 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2440 ----+-----+-----+----
2441 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024454.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2446--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002448The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2449limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2450they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2451limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002452marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002453option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002454and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2455with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2456specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002458
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002459 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2460------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2461acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462backlog X X X -
2463balance X - X X
2464bind - X X -
2465bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002466capture cookie - X X -
2467capture request header - X X -
2468capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002469compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002471declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472default-server X - X X
2473default_backend X X X -
2474description - X X X
2475disabled X X X X
2476dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002477email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002478email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002479email-alert mailers X X X X
2480email-alert myhostname X X X X
2481email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482enabled X X X X
2483errorfile X X X X
2484errorloc X X X X
2485errorloc302 X X X X
2486-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2487errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002488force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002489filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002490fullconn X - X X
2491grace X X X X
2492hash-type X - X X
2493http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002494http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002495http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002497http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002498http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002499http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002501ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002502load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002503log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002504log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002505log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002506log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002507max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508maxconn X X X -
2509mode X X X X
2510monitor fail - X X -
2511monitor-net X X X -
2512monitor-uri X X X -
2513option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2514option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2515option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2516option allbackups (*) X - X X
2517option checkcache (*) X - X X
2518option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2519option contstats (*) X X X -
2520option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2521option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002522-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2523option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002524option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2525option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002526option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002527option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002528option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002529option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002530option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002531option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2532option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2533option httpchk X - X X
2534option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002535option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002537option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002538option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002539option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002540option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2541option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2542option logasap (*) X X X -
2543option mysql-check X - X X
2544option nolinger (*) X X X X
2545option originalto X X X X
2546option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002547option pgsql-check X - X X
2548option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002550option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002551option smtpchk X - X X
2552option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2553option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2554option splice-request (*) X X X X
2555option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002556option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2558option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2559-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002560option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002561option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2562option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2563option tcpka X X X X
2564option tcplog X X X X
2565option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002566external-check command X - X X
2567external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002568persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2569rate-limit sessions X X X -
2570redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002573retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002574server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002575server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002576server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002577source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002578stats admin - X X X
2579stats auth X X X X
2580stats enable X X X X
2581stats hide-version X X X X
2582stats http-request - X X X
2583stats realm X X X X
2584stats refresh X X X X
2585stats scope X X X X
2586stats show-desc X X X X
2587stats show-legends X X X X
2588stats show-node X X X X
2589stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002590-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2591stick match - - X X
2592stick on - - X X
2593stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002594stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002595stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002596tcp-check connect - - X X
2597tcp-check expect - - X X
2598tcp-check send - - X X
2599tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002600tcp-request connection - X X -
2601tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002602tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002603tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002604tcp-response content - - X X
2605tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002606timeout check X - X X
2607timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002608timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002609timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2611timeout http-request X X X X
2612timeout queue X - X X
2613timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002614timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002615timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002616timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002618unique-id-format X X X -
2619unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002621use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002622use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2624 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026274.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2628---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629
2630This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2631
2632
2633acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2634 Declare or complete an access list.
2635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2636 no | yes | yes | yes
2637 Example:
2638 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2639 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2640 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002642 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643
2644
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002645backlog <conns>
2646 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2648 yes | yes | yes | no
2649 Arguments :
2650 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2651 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002652 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002653
2654 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2655 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2656 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2657 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2658 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2659 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2660 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2661 backlog parameter.
2662
2663 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2664 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2665 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2666
2667 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2668
2669
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002671balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2674 yes | no | yes | yes
2675 Arguments :
2676 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2677 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2678 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2679 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2680
2681 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2682 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2683 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2684 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002685 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002686 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002687 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2688 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2689 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2690 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2691 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2692 it, so that you don't worry.
2693
2694 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2695 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2696 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2697 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2698 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2699 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2700 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2701 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002703 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2704 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2705 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2706 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2707 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2708 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2709 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2710 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2711
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002712 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002713 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002714 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2715 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002716 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002717 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2718 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2719 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2720 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2721 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002722 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2723 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2724 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2725 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2726 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2727 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002728
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002729 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2730 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2731 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2732 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2733 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2734 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2735 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2736 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002737 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002739 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2740 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2741 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002743 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2744 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2745 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2746 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2747 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2748 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2749 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2750 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2751 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2752 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2753 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2754 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002756 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002757 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2758 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2759 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2760 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2761 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2762 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2763 URIs start with a leading "/".
2764
2765 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2766 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2767 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2768 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002771 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2772
2773 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002774 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2775 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002776 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2777 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2778 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2779 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002780 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002781 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2782 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002783
2784 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2785 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2786 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2787 server will receive the request.
2788
2789 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2790 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2791 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2792 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2793 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002794 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2795 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2796 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002798 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2799 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2800 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2801 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2802 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002804 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002805 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2806 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2807 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2808
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002809 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2810 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2811 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2812
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002813 random
2814 random(<draws>)
2815 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002816 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2817 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2818 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2819 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002820 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2821 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2822 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2823 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2824 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2825 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2826 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2827 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2828 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2829 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2830 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2831 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2832 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2833 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2834 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2835 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2836 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2837 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2838 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2839 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002840
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002841 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002842 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002843 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2844 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2845 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2846 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2847 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2848 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002849 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002850 used instead.
2851
2852 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2853 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2854 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2855 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2856
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002857 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2858 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2859 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2860
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002861 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002864 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2865 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002866
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002867 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2868 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2869 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002871 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002872 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002873 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2874 NTLM relies on.
2875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002876 Examples :
2877 balance roundrobin
2878 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002879 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002880 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2881 balance hdr(host)
2882 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002883
2884 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2885 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002887 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002888 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2889 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2890 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002891 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002892
2893 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2894 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2895 defaults to 16 kB.
2896
2897 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2898 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2899
2900 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2901 Round Robin.
2902
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002903 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002904 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2905 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2906 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2907
2908 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2909
2910 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002911 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002912 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2913 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2914 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002915
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002916 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
2918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002919bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2920bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2923 no | yes | yes | no
2924 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002925 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2926 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2927 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2928 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002929 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002930 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2931 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2932 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2933 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2934 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2935 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2936 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002937 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2938 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2939 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2940 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2941 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2942 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2943 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002944 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2945 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2946 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002947 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2948 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2949 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2950 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002951 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2952 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2953 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002954
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002955 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2956 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002957 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2958 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2959 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002960 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2961 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2962 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2963 the range.
2964
2965 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2966 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2967 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2968 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2969 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2970 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2971 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002972 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002973 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002975 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002976 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002977 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2978 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2979 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2980 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2981 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2982 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002984 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2985 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2986 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2987 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002989 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2990 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2991 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2992 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2993 in a frontend.
2994
2995 Example :
2996 listen http_proxy
2997 bind :80,:443
2998 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002999 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003001 listen http_https_proxy
3002 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003003 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003004
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003005 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3006 bind ipv6@:80
3007 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3008 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3009
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003010 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003011 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003012
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003013 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3014 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3015 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3016 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3017 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3018
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003019 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003020 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003021
3022
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003023bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003024 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | yes | yes | yes
3027 Arguments :
3028 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3029 may be used to override a default value.
3030
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003031 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003032 option may be combined with other numbers.
3033
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003034 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003035 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3036 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3037 missing from all processes.
3038
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003039 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003040 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003041 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3042 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3043 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3044 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3045 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003046 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003047
3048 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3049 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3050 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3051 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3052 and 'even' instances.
3053
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003054 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3055 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3056 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3057 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003058
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003059 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3060 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3061
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003062 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3063 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3064 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3065
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003066 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3067 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3068
3069 Example :
3070 listen app_ip1
3071 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003072 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003073
3074 listen app_ip2
3075 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003076 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003077
3078 listen management
3079 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003080 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003082 listen management
3083 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3084 bind-process 1-4
3085
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003086 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003087
3088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089capture cookie <name> len <length>
3090 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 no | yes | yes | no
3093 Arguments :
3094 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3095 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3096 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3097 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003098 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099
3100 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3101 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3102 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3103 right if it exceeds <length>.
3104
3105 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3106 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3107 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3108 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3109
3110 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3111 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3112 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3113
3114 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3115 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3116 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003117 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3118 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3119 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121 Example:
3122 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3123
3124 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003125 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126
3127
3128capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003129 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3131 no | yes | yes | no
3132 Arguments :
3133 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003134 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003135 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3136 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3137 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3138
3139 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3140 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3141 it exceeds <length>.
3142
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003143 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3145 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003146 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3147 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3148 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3149 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003150 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003151 environments to find where the request came from.
3152
3153 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3154 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3155 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3156 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003158 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3159 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3160 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3161 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3162 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163
3164 Example:
3165 capture request header Host len 15
3166 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003167 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003169 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 about logging.
3171
3172
3173capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003174 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 no | yes | yes | no
3177 Arguments :
3178 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003179 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003180 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3181 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3182 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3183
3184 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3185 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3186 it exceeds <length>.
3187
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003188 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003189 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3190 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3191 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003192 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3193 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3194 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3195 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003197 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3198 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3199 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3200 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3201 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202
3203 Example:
3204 capture response header Content-length len 9
3205 capture response header Location len 15
3206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003207 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003208 about logging.
3209
3210
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003211compression algo <algorithm> ...
3212compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003213compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003214 Enable HTTP compression.
3215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3216 yes | yes | yes | yes
3217 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003218 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3219 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3220 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3221
3222 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003223 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3224 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3225 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003226
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003227 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003228 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003229
3230 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3231 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3232 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3233 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3234 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003235 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003236
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003237 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3238 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3239 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3240 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3241 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3242 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3243 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003244 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003245
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003246 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003247 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003248 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3249 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3250 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3251 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3252 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003253
3254 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3255 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3256 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3257 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3258 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003259 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3260 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3261 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3262 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3263 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003264 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3265 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003266
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003267 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003268 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3269 "Accept-Encoding" header
3270 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003271 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003272 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3273 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3274 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3275 "multipart"
3276 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3277 header
3278 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3279 and later
3280 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3281 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003282 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003283
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003284 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003285
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003286 Examples :
3287 compression algo gzip
3288 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003289
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003291cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003292 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3293 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003294 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3297 yes | no | yes | yes
3298 Arguments :
3299 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3300 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3301 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3302 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3303 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3304 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003305 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3307 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3308
3309 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3310 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3311 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3312 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3313 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3314 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003315 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3316 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003317 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003318 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3319 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320
3321 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003322 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003323
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003324 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003325 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003326 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003327 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003328 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3329 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3330 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3331 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3332 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3333 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3334 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335
3336 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3337 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3338 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3339 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3340 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3341 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3342 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3343 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3344 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003345 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003346 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3347 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3348 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003349
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003350 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3351 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3352 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003353 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3354 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3355 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3356 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003357 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3358 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3359 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360
3361 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3362 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3363 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3364 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3365 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3366 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3367 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3368 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3369 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3370
3371 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3372 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3373 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3374 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3375 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3376 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3377 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3378 persistence cookie in the cache.
3379 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3380
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003381 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3382 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3383 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3384 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3385 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003387 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3388 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3389 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3390 they logout.
3391
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003392 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3393 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3394 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3395 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3396
3397 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3398 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3399 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3400 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3401 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3402 this attribute.
3403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003404 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003405 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003406 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3407 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3408 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3409 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3410 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3411 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003413 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3414 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3415 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3416 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3417 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3418 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3419 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3420 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003421 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003422 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3423 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3424 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3425 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3426 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3427 the site.
3428
3429 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3430 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3431 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3432 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3433 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3434 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3435 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3436 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3437 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3438 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3439 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3440 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3441 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003442 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003443 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3444 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3445
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003446 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3447 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3448 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3449 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3450 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3451 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3452
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003453 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3454 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3455 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3456 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003458 Examples :
3459 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3460 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3461 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003462 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003464 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003466
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003467declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3468 Declares a capture slot.
3469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3470 no | yes | yes | no
3471 Arguments:
3472 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3473
3474 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3475 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3476 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3477 for use in the response.
3478
3479 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003480 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003481 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3482
3483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003484default-server [param*]
3485 Change default options for a server in a backend
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | no | yes | yes
3488 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003489 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3490 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3491 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3492 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003493
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003494 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003495 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3496
3497 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500default_backend <backend>
3501 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3503 yes | yes | yes | no
3504 Arguments :
3505 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3506
3507 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3508 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3509 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3510 will catch all undetermined requests.
3511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512 Example :
3513
3514 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3515 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3516 default_backend dynamic
3517
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003518 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003521description <string>
3522 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3524 no | yes | yes | yes
3525 Arguments : string
3526
3527 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3528 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3529 it describes.
3530 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3531
3532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533disabled
3534 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | yes | yes | yes
3537 Arguments : none
3538
3539 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3540 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3541 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3542 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3543 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3544 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3545 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3546
3547 See also : "enabled"
3548
3549
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003550dispatch <address>:<port>
3551 Set a default server address
3552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3553 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003555
3556 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3557 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3558 during start-up.
3559
3560 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3561 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3562 possible with normal servers.
3563
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003564 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003565 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3566 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3567 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3568 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3569
3570 See also : "server"
3571
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003572
3573dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3574 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3576 yes | no | yes | yes
3577 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3578
3579 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003580 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003581 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3582 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003583 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003584 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586enabled
3587 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 yes | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : none
3591
3592 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3593 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3594
3595 See also : "disabled"
3596
3597
3598errorfile <code> <file>
3599 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments :
3603 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003604 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3605 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606
3607 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003608 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003610 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3611 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612
3613 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3614 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3615 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3616
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003617 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3620 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3621 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3622 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3623
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003624 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3625 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003626 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003627 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3628 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3629 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003631 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3632 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3633 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003634 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3636
3637 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3638
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003639 Example :
3640 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003641 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003642 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3643 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003645
3646errorloc <code> <url>
3647errorloc302 <code> <url>
3648 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3650 yes | yes | yes | yes
3651 Arguments :
3652 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003653 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3654 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003655
3656 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3657 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3658 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3659 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003660 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003661
3662 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3663 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3664 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3665
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003666 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3667
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003668 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3669 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3670 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3671 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003672 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003673 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3674 request.
3675
3676 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3677
3678
3679errorloc303 <code> <url>
3680 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | yes | yes | yes
3683 Arguments :
3684 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003685 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3686 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003687
3688 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3689 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3690 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3691 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003692 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003693
3694 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3695 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3696 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3697
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003698 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003700 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3701 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3702 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3703 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003704 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003705
3706 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3707
3708
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003709email-alert from <emailaddr>
3710 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003711 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3713 yes | yes | yes | yes
3714
3715 Arguments :
3716
3717 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3718
3719 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3720 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3721
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003722 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003723 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3724 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003725
3726
3727email-alert level <level>
3728 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3729 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 yes | yes | yes | yes
3732
3733 Arguments :
3734
3735 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3736 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3737 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3738
3739 By default level is alert
3740
3741 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3742 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3743 for the proxy.
3744
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003745 Alerts are sent when :
3746
3747 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3748 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3749 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3750 is notice or lower
3751 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3752 and a health check status update occurs
3753
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003754 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3755 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003756 section 3.6 about mailers.
3757
3758
3759email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3760 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | yes
3763
3764 Arguments :
3765
3766 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3767
3768 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3769 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3770
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003771 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3772 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003773
3774
3775email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3776 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3777 mailers.
3778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | yes
3780
3781 Arguments :
3782
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003783 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003784
3785 By default the systems hostname is used.
3786
3787 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3788 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3789 for the proxy.
3790
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003791 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3792 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003793
3794
3795email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003796 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003797 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3799 yes | yes | yes | yes
3800
3801 Arguments :
3802
3803 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3804
3805 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3806 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3807
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003808 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003809 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3810
3811
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003812force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3813 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003815 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003816
3817 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3818 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3819 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3820 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3821 marked down for maintenance operations.
3822
3823 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3824 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3825 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3826 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3827 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3828 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3829 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3830 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3831 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3832
3833 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3834 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3835 is used.
3836
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003837 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003838 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003839
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003840
3841filter <name> [param*]
3842 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 no | yes | yes | yes
3845 Arguments :
3846 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3847 referenced in section 9.
3848
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003849 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003850 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003851 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3852 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003853
3854 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3855 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3856
3857 Example:
3858 listen
3859 bind *:80
3860
3861 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3862 filter compression
3863 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3864
3865 compression algo gzip
3866 compression offload
3867
3868 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3869
3870 See also : section 9.
3871
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003872
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003873fullconn <conns>
3874 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | no | yes | yes
3877 Arguments :
3878 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3879 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3880
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003881 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003882 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003883 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003884 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3885 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3886 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3887 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3888 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003889 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003891 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3892 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003893 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3894 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3895 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003896
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003897 Example :
3898 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3899 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3900 # connections.
3901 backend dynamic
3902 fullconn 10000
3903 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3904 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3905
3906 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3907
3908
3909grace <time>
3910 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003912 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003913 Arguments :
3914 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3915 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3916 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3917
3918 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3919 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003920 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003921 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3922
3923 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3924 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3925 simplify it.
3926
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003927
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003928hash-balance-factor <factor>
3929 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3931 yes | no | no | yes
3932 Arguments :
3933 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3934 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003935 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003936
3937 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3938 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3939 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3940 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3941 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3942 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3943 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3944
3945 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3946 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3947 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3948 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3949 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3950
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003951 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3952 consistent hashing mechanism.
3953
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003954 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3955
3956
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003957hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003958 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | no | yes | yes
3961 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003962 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3963 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003964
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003965 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3966 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3967 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3968 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3969 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3970 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3971 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3972 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3973 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3974 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003975
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003976 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3977 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3978 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3979 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3980 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3981 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3982 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3983 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3984 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3985 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3986 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3987 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3988 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003989 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3990 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003991
3992 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3993
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003994 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003995 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3996 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3997 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003998 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3999 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4000 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004001
4002 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4003 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004004 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4005 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4006 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4007 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4008
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004009 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4010 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4011 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4012 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4013 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4014 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4015 parameter.
4016
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004017 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4018 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4019 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4020 used on strings.
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4023
4024 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4025 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4026 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4027 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4028 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4029 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4030 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4031 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4032 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4033 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4034 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4035 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004036
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004037 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4038 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4039 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004040
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004041 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004042
4043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004044http-check disable-on-404
4045 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004047 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004048 Arguments : none
4049
4050 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4051 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4052 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4053 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4054 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4055 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4056 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4057 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004058 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4059 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4060 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4061
4062 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4063
4064
4065http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004066 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004068 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004069 Arguments :
4070 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4071 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004072 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004073 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4074 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4075 details on the supported keywords.
4076
4077 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4078 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4079 with the usual backslash ('\').
4080
4081 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4082 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4083 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4084 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4085 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4086
4087 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004088 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004089 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4090 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4091 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4092
4093 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004094 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004095 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4096 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4097 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4098 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4099
4100 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004101 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004102 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4103 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4104 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4105 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4106 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004107 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004108 trace).
4109
4110 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004111 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004112 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4113 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4114 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4115 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4116 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004117 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004118
4119 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4120 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4121 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4122 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4123 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4124 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4125 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4126 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4127
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004128 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4129 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4130 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4131
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4133 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4134
4135 Examples :
4136 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004137 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138
4139 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004140 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004141
4142 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004143 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004144
4145 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004146 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004148 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004149
4150
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004151http-check send-state
4152 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4154 yes | no | yes | yes
4155 Arguments : none
4156
4157 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4158 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4159 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4160 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4161 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4162
4163 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4164 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4165 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4166 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4167 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004168 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4169 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4170 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4171
4172 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4173 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4174 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4175
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004176 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4177 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4178 checked in multiple backends.
4179
4180 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4181 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4182
4183 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4184 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4185 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4186 one fails.
4187
4188 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4189 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4190 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4191
4192 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4193 server's queue.
4194
4195 Example of a header received by the application server :
4196 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4197 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4198
4199 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004201
4202http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004203 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4204
4205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 no | yes | yes | yes
4207
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004208 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4209 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4210 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4211 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4212 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4215 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 Example:
4220 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4221 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4222 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 http-request allow if nagios
4225 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4226 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4227 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004229 Example:
4230 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4231 acl add path /addacl
4232 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4237 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239 Example:
4240 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4241 acl setmap path /setmap
4242 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4247 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4250 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004254 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4255 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4256 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4257 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4258 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4259 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4260 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4261 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004263http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004265 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4266 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4267 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4268 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4269 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4270 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4271 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4272 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4277 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004278
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4283 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4284 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4285 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4286 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288 Example:
4289 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4290 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004291
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004292http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004293
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004294 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4300 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4301 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4302 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4303 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4304 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4305 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4306 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4307 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4310 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4311 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4312 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4313 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4314 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4319 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4320 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4321 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4322 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4323 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4335 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4336 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4341 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4342 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4343 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4344 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004345
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004346http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4347 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4348 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4349 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4350
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004351http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4352
4353 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4354 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4355 pointed by <resolvers>.
4356 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4357 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4358 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4359 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4360 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4361 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4362 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4363 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4364 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4365 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4366 to 0.0.0.0.
4367
4368 Example:
4369 resolvers mydns
4370 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4371 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4372 timeout retry 1s
4373 hold valid 10s
4374 hold nx 3s
4375 hold other 3s
4376 hold obsolete 0s
4377 accepted_payload_size 8192
4378
4379 frontend fe
4380 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4381 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4382 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4383
4384 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4385 # which mean DNS resolution error
4386 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4387
4388 default_backend be
4389
4390 backend b_503
4391 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4392 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4393 # 503 error page to end users
4394
4395 backend be
4396 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4397 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4398 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4399 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4400 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4401
4402 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4403 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4404
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004405http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4406
4407 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4408 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4409 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4410 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004411 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4412 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004413
4414 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4419 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4420 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4421 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4422 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4427 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4428 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4429 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4432 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004433
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004434 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4435 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4436 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4437 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4438 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4439 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004440
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004441 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4442 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4443 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4444 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4445 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004446
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004447 Example:
4448 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4449
4450 # applied to:
4451 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4452
4453 # outputs:
4454 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4455
4456 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004458 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4459
4460 # applied to:
4461 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004462
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004463 # outputs:
4464 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004465
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004466http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4468
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004469 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4470 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4471 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4472 against.
4473
4474 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4475 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4476 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004477
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004478 Example:
4479 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4480 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004481
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004482 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4483 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004484
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004485 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4486 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4487 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4488 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4491 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004492
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004493 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4494 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4495 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4496 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004497
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004498 Example:
4499 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004500
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004501 # applied to:
4502 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004503
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004504 # outputs:
4505 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4508http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004510 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4511 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4512 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004513
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004514http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4515 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004516
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004517 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4518 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4519 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4520 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004524 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4525 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4526 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4527 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4528 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 Arguments:
4531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4532 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004534 Example:
4535 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4536 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4539 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4544 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4545 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547 Arguments:
4548 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4549 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004551 Example:
4552 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4553 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004555 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4556 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4557 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4562 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4563 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4564 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4565 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567 Example:
4568 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4569 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4570 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4571 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4572 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4573 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4574 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4575 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004578http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4581 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4582 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4583 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4584 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4587 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4590 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4591 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4592 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4593 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4594 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4595 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4596 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4597 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4602 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4603 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4604 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4605 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4606 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4607 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4612 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4613 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4618 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4619 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4620 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4621 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4622 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4623 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4624 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004626http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004628 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4629 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4630 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4631 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4632 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4633 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635 Example :
4636 # prepend the host name before the path
4637 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004639http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4642 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4643 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4644 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4645 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4650 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4651 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4652 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4653 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4654 values have higher priority.
4655 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4656 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4657 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4658 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4659 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4664 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4665 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4666 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4667 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4668 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4669 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004672
4673 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4675 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4678 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4679 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4680 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4681 privacy.
4682
4683 Arguments :
4684 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4685 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004686
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004687 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4689 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4690
4691 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4692 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4693
4694http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4695
4696 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4697 expression.
4698
4699 Arguments:
4700 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4701 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004702
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004703 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004704 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4705 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4706
4707 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4708 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4709 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4710
4711http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4712
4713 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4714 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4715 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4716 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4717 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4718 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4719 information from the request.
4720
4721 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4722
4723http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4724
4725 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4726 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4727 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4728 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4729 path and the query string.
4730 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4731
4732http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4733
4734 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4735 inline.
4736
4737 Arguments:
4738 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4739 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4740 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4741 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4742 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4743 (request and response)
4744 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4745 processing
4746 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4747 processing
4748 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4749 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4750 and '_'.
4751
4752 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4753 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004754
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004755 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004756 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4759 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004761 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4762 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4763 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4764 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4765 agent name must be used.
4766
4767 Arguments:
4768 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4769
4770 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4771 configuration.
4772
4773http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4774
4775 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4776 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4777 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4778 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4779 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4780 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4781 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4782 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4783 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4784 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4785 action.
4786 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4787 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4788 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4789 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4790 you fully understand how it works.
4791
4792http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4793
4794 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4795 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4796 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4797 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4798 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4799 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4800 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4801 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4802 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4803 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4804 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4805 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4806 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4807
4808http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4809http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4810http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811
4812 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4813 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4814 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4815 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4816 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4817 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4818 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4819 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4820 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4821 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4822 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4823 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4824
4825 Arguments :
4826 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4827 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4828 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4829 select which table entry to update the counters.
4830
4831 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4832 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4833 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4834 that table until the session ends.
4835
4836 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4837 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4838 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4839 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4840 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4841 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4842 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4843 useful information.
4844
4845 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4846 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4847 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4848 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4849 checks that make use of it.
4850
4851http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4852
4853 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004854
4855 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004856 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004857
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004858http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4859
4860 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4861 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4862 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4863 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4864 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4865 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4866
4867 Arguments :
4868 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4869
4870 Example:
4871 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004873http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004875 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4876 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4877 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004878
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004881 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4882
4883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 no | yes | yes | yes
4885
4886 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4887 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4888 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4889 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4890 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4891 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004893 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4894 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004896 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898 Example:
4899 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004900
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004901 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4904 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 Example:
4907 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004909 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4912 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004914 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4915 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4920 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4921 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4922 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4923 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4924 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4925 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4926 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004928http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4931 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4932 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4933 example, or to pass some internal information.
4934 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4935 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4936 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004940 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4941 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004942
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004943http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004944
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004945 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004949 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4950 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4951 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4952 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4953 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4954 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4955 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004957 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4958 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4959 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4960 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4961 keyword.
4962 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4963 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004965http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4968 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4969 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4970 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4971 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4972 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004974http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4981 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4982 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4983 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4984 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4985 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004987http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004989 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4990 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004991
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004992http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004993
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004994 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4995 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4996 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4997 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4998 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4999 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005001http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005003
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005004 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5005 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007 Example:
5008 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 # applied to:
5011 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013 # outputs:
5014 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5019 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005020
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005021 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5022 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 Example:
5025 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027 # applied to:
5028 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 # outputs:
5031 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5034http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5037 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5038 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005039
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005040http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5041 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005042
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005043 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5044 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5045 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5046 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005048http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005050 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5051 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5052 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5053 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5054 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005056 Arguments:
5057 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5060 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5065 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5066 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005068http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5069
5070 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5071 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5072 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5073 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5074 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5075
5076http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5077
5078 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5079 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5080 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5081 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5082 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5083 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5084 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5085 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5086 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5087
5088http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5089
5090 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5091 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5092 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5093 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5094 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5095 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5096 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5097
5098http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5099
5100 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5101 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5102 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5103 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5104 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5105 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5106 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5107 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5108
5109http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5110 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5111
5112 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5113 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5114 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5115 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005116
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005117 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5119 http-response set-status 431
5120 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5121 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005123http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5126 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5127 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5128 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5129 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5130 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5131 based on some information from the request.
5132
5133 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5134
5135http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5136
5137 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5138 inline.
5139
5140 Arguments:
5141 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5142 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5143 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5144 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5145 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5146 (request and response)
5147 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5148 processing
5149 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5150 processing
5151 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5152 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5153 and '_'.
5154
5155 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5156 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005157
5158 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005159 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005161http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005163 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5164 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5165 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5166 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5167 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5168 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5169 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5170 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5171 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5172 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5173 action.
5174 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5175 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5176 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5177 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5178 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005180http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5181http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5182http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5185 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5186 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5187 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5188 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5189 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5190
5191http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5192
5193 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5194 about <var-name>.
5195
5196 Example:
5197 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5198
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005199
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005200http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5201 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5202
5203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5204 yes | no | yes | yes
5205
5206 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005207 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5208 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5209 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005210
5211 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5212
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005213 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5214 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5215 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5216 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5217 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5218 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5219 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5220 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5221 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5222 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005223
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005224 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5225 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5226 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5227 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5228 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5229 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5230 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5231 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005232
5233 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5234 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5235 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5236 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5237 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5238 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5239 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5240 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005241 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005242 downsides of rare connection failures.
5243
5244 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5245 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5246 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5247 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5248 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5249 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005250 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005251 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5252 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5253 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5254 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5255 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5256
5257 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005258 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5259 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5260 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005261
5262 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005263 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005264
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005265 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5266 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005267
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005268 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005269
5270 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5271 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5272 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5273
5274 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5275
5276
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005277http-send-name-header [<header>]
5278 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5280 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005281 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005282 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5283
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005284 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5285 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5286 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5287 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5288 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5289 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5290 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5291 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5292 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5293 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5294 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5295 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5296 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5297 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5298 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5299 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005300
5301 See also : "server"
5302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005303id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005304 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 no | yes | yes | yes
5307 Arguments : none
5308
5309 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5310 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5311 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005312
5313
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005314ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5315 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5316 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005317 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005318
5319 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5320 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5321 and running).
5322
5323 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5324 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5325 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005326 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005327 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5328
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005329 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5330 "unless" condition is met.
5331
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005332 Example:
5333 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5334 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5335 ignore-persist if url_static
5336
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005337 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5338
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005339load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5340 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 yes | no | yes | yes
5343
5344 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5345 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5346 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005347 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005348 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5349 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5350 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5351 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005353 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005354 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005355 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005356
5357 Arguments:
5358 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5359 named "server-state-file".
5360
5361 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5362 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5363 name is used as a file name.
5364
5365 none don't load any stat for this backend
5366
5367 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005368 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5369 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5370 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005371 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005372 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005373
5374 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5375 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5376
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005377 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005378
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005379 global
5380 stats socket /tmp/socket
5381 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005382
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005383 defaults
5384 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005385
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005386 backend bk
5387 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5388 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005389
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005390
5391 Then one can run :
5392
5393 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5394
5395 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5396
5397 1
5398 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5399 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5400 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5401
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005402 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005403
5404 global
5405 stats socket /tmp/socket
5406 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5407
5408 defaults
5409 load-server-state-from-file local
5410
5411 backend bk
5412 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5413 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5414
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005415
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005416 Then one can run :
5417
5418 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5419
5420 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5421
5422 1
5423 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5424 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5425 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5426
5427 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5428 "show servers state"
5429
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005430
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005431log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005432log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5433 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005434no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005435 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005438
5439 Prefix :
5440 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5441 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5442 prefix does not allow arguments.
5443
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005444 Arguments :
5445 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5446 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5447 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5448 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5449 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5450 parameter.
5451
5452 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5453 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5454
5455 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5456 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5457 standard syslog port).
5458
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005459 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5460 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5461 standard syslog port).
5462
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005463 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5464 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5465 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005466 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005467
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005468 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5469 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5470 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5471 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5472 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5473 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5474 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5475 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5476 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5477 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5478 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5479 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5480 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5481 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5482 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5483 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005484 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5485 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005486
5487 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5488 and "fd@2", see above.
5489
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005490 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5491 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5492 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5493 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5494 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5495 having the logs instantly available.
5496
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005497 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5498 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005499
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005500 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5501 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5502 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5503 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5504 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5505 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5506 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5507 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5508 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5509 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005510 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005511
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005512 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5513 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5514 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5515 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5516 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5517
5518 <sample_size>
5519 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5520 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5521 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5522 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5523 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5524
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005525 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5526 one of the following :
5527
5528 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5529 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5530
5531 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5532 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5533
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005534 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5535 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5536 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5537 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5538 systemd logger consumes.
5539
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005540 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5541 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5542 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5543 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5544
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005545 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5546
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005547 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5548 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5549 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5550
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005551 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5552 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5553 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5554 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005555
5556 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5557 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5558 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005559 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5560 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5561 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5562 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5563 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005564
5565 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5566
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005567 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5568 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5569 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005570
5571 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5572 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5573 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5574 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5575
5576 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5577 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005578
5579 Example :
5580 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005581 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5582 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5583 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005584 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5585 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005586 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005588
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005589log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005590 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5591 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5592 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005593
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005594 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5595 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5596 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5597 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5598 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005599
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005600 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5601 "option httplog" directives.
5602
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005603log-format-sd <string>
5604 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 yes | yes | yes | no
5607
5608 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5609 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5610 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5611 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5612 which covers the log format string in depth.
5613
5614 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5615 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5616
5617 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5618 log format to "rfc5424".
5619
5620 Example :
5621 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5622
5623
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005624log-tag <string>
5625 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | yes | yes | yes
5628
5629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5630 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5631 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5632 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5633 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5634 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5635 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5636 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5637 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005638
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005639max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5640 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5642 yes | no | yes | yes
5643
5644 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5645 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5646 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5647 servers.
5648
5649 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5650 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5651 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5652 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5653 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005654 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005655 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5656 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5657 picking a different server.
5658
5659 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5660 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5661 even if they have to be queued.
5662
5663 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5664 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5665
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005666max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5667 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5668 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5669 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005670
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005671maxconn <conns>
5672 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5674 yes | yes | yes | no
5675 Arguments :
5676 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5677 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5678 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5679 closes.
5680
5681 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5682 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5683 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5684 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005685 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5686 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5687 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5688 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005689
5690 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5691 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5692 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5693
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005694 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5695 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005696
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5698
5699
5700mode { tcp|http|health }
5701 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5703 yes | yes | yes | yes
5704 Arguments :
5705 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5706 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5707 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5708 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5709
5710 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5711 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5712 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5713 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5714 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5715
5716 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005717 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5718 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5719 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5720 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5721 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5722 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5723 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005724
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005725 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5726 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5727 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005728
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005729 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730 defaults http_instances
5731 mode http
5732
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005733 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005735
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005736monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005737 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5739 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005740 Arguments :
5741 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5742 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005743 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005744 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5745 backend and its backup.
5746
5747 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5748 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5749 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5750 servers in a list of backends.
5751
5752 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5753 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5754 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5755 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5756 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5757 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5758 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005759 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5760 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005761
5762 Example:
5763 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005764 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005765 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5766 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5767 monitor-uri /site_alive
5768 monitor fail if site_dead
5769
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005770 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005771
5772
5773monitor-net <source>
5774 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | yes | yes | no
5777 Arguments :
5778 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5779 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5780 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5781 followed by a mask.
5782
5783 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5784 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005785 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005786 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5787
5788 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5789 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5790 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5791 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005792 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5793 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5794 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005795
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005796 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5797 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5798 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5799 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5800 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5801 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005802
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005803 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5804 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005805
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005806 Example :
5807 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5808 frontend www
5809 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5810
5811 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5812
5813
5814monitor-uri <uri>
5815 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5817 yes | yes | yes | no
5818 Arguments :
5819 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5820 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5821
5822 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5823 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5824 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5825 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5826 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5827 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5828 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5829 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5830
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005831 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005832 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5833 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5834 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5835 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5836 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5837 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005838
5839 Example :
5840 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5841 frontend www
5842 mode http
5843 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5844
5845 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5846
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005847
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005848option abortonclose
5849no option abortonclose
5850 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5852 yes | no | yes | yes
5853 Arguments : none
5854
5855 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5856 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5857 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5858 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005859 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005860 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5861 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5862 encountered while delivering the response.
5863
5864 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5865 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5866 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5867 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5868 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5869 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005870 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005871 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005872 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005873 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5874 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5875 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5876
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005877 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5878 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005879 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5880 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5881 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5882 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5883 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5884 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005885 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005886
5887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5889
5890 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5891
5892
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005893option accept-invalid-http-request
5894no option accept-invalid-http-request
5895 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5897 yes | yes | yes | no
5898 Arguments : none
5899
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005900 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005901 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005902 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005903 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5904 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5905 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5906 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5907 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005908 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5909 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5910 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5911 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005912 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005913 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005914 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5915 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5916 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005917
5918 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5919 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5920 been confirmed.
5921
5922 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5923 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005924 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5925 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005926 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5927
5928 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5929 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5930
5931 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5932 stats socket.
5933
5934
5935option accept-invalid-http-response
5936no option accept-invalid-http-response
5937 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5939 yes | no | yes | yes
5940 Arguments : none
5941
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005942 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005943 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005944 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005945 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5946 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5947 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5948 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5949 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005950 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5951 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5952 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005953
5954 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5955 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5956 been confirmed.
5957
5958 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5959 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5960 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5961 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5962
5963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5965
5966 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5967 stats socket.
5968
5969
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005970option allbackups
5971no option allbackups
5972 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 yes | no | yes | yes
5975 Arguments : none
5976
5977 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5978 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5979 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5980 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5981 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5982 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5983 order between the backup servers anymore.
5984
5985 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5986 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5987
5988 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5989 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5990
5991
5992option checkcache
5993no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005994 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | no | yes | yes
5997 Arguments : none
5998
5999 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6000 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006001 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006002 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6003 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006004 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006005
6006 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006007 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006008 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006009 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6010 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006011 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006012 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006013 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6014 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006015 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006016 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6017 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006018 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006019 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6020 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6021 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6022 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6023 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6024 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6025 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6026 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6027 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6028
6029 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006030 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6031 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6032 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6033 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006034
6035 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6036 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006037 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006038 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006039
6040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6042
6043
6044option clitcpka
6045no option clitcpka
6046 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6048 yes | yes | yes | no
6049 Arguments : none
6050
6051 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6052 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006053 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006054 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6055
6056 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6057 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6058 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6059 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6060
6061 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6062 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6063 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6064 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6065 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6066
6067 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6068
6069 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6070 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6071 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6072
6073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6075
6076 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6077
6078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006079option contstats
6080 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | yes | yes | no
6083 Arguments : none
6084
6085 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6086 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6087 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6088 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006089 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6090 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6091 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6092 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6093 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006094
6095
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006096option dontlog-normal
6097no option dontlog-normal
6098 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6100 yes | yes | yes | no
6101 Arguments : none
6102
6103 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6104 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6105 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6106 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6107 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6108 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6109 logged.
6110
6111 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6112 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6113 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006115 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006116 logging.
6117
6118
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006119option dontlognull
6120no option dontlognull
6121 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6123 yes | yes | yes | no
6124 Arguments : none
6125
6126 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6127 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6128 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6129 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6130 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6131 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006132 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6133 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6134 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006135
6136 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006137 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006138 would not be logged.
6139
6140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6142
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006143 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6144 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006145
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006146
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006147option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006148 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6150 yes | yes | yes | yes
6151 Arguments :
6152 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6153 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006154 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006155 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006156
6157 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6158 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6159 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6160 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6161 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6162 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6163 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006164 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6165 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6166 possible that the client has already brought one.
6167
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006168 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006169 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006170 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006171 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006172 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006173 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006174
6175 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6176 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6177 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6178 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6179 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6180 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6181 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6182
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006183 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6184 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6185 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6186 are under the control of the end-user.
6187
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006188 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006189 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6190 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006191 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6192 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6193 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006194
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006195 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006196 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6197 frontend www
6198 mode http
6199 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6200
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006201 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6202 backend www
6203 mode http
6204 option forwardfor header X-Client
6205
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006206 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006207 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006208
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006209
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006210option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6211no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6212 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6214 yes | yes | yes | no
6215 Arguments : none
6216
6217 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6218 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6219 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6220 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6221 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6222 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6223 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6224
6225 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6226 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6227 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6228 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6229 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6230 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6231 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6232 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6233 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6234 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6235
6236 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6237
6238 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6239 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6240
6241 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6242 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6243
6244
6245option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6246no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6247 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6249 yes | no | yes | yes
6250 Arguments : none
6251
6252 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6253 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6254 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6255 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6256 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6257 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6258 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6259
6260 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6261 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6262 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6263 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6264 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6265 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6266 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6267 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6268 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6269 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6270
6271 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6272
6273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6275
6276 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6277 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6278
6279
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006280option http-buffer-request
6281no option http-buffer-request
6282 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6284 yes | yes | yes | yes
6285 Arguments : none
6286
6287 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6288 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6289 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6290 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6291 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6292 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006293 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6294 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6295 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6296 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006297
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006298 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006299
6300
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006301option http-ignore-probes
6302no option http-ignore-probes
6303 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6305 yes | yes | yes | no
6306 Arguments : none
6307
6308 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6309 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6310 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6311 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6312 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6313 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6314 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6315 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6316 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006317 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6318 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006319 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6320
6321 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6322 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6323 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6324 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6325 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6326 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6327 are often the only way to detect them.
6328
6329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6331
6332 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6333
6334
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006335option http-keep-alive
6336no option http-keep-alive
6337 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6339 yes | yes | yes | yes
6340 Arguments : none
6341
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006342 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6343 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006344 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6345 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006346 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6347 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6348 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006349
6350 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6351 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006352 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6353 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6354 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6355 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6356 situations where this option may be useful :
6357
6358 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006359 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006360
6361 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6362 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6363
6364 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6365 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6366 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6367 request.
6368
6369 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6370 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006371 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6372 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6373 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006374
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006375 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6376 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6377 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6378 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6379 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6380 not set.
6381
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006382 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6383 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6384 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006385
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006386 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006387 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006388 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006389
6390
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006391option http-no-delay
6392no option http-no-delay
6393 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | yes | yes | yes
6396 Arguments : none
6397
6398 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6399 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6400 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6401 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6402 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6403 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6404 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6405 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6406 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6407 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6408 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6409 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6410 affected.
6411
6412 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6413 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6414 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6415 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6416 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6417 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6418 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6419 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6420 latency environments.
6421
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006422 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6423
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006424
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006425option http-pretend-keepalive
6426no option http-pretend-keepalive
6427 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006429 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006430 Arguments : none
6431
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006432 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006433 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6434 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6435 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6436 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6437 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6438 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6439 consider the response complete.
6440
6441 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6442 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6443 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6444 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006445 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006446 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6447
6448 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6449 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6450 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6451 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6452 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6453 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6454 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6455
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006456 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6457 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6458 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6459 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6460 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6461 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006462
6463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6465
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006466 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006467 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006468
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006469
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006470option http-server-close
6471no option http-server-close
6472 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6474 yes | yes | yes | yes
6475 Arguments : none
6476
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006477 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6478 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6479 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6480 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006481 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6482 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6483 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6484 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6485 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6486 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6487 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6488 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6489 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6490 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6491 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006492
6493 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6494 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6495 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6496 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006497 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6498 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006499
6500 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6501 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006502 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6503 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6504 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006505
6506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006509 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6510 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006511
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006512option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006513no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006514 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6516 yes | yes | yes | no
6517 Arguments : none
6518
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006519 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006520 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6521 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6522 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6523 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6524 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6525 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6526
6527 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6528 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006529 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6530 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6531 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006532
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006533 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6534 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6535 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6536 front of an existing proxy.
6537
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006538 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6539
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006540 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006541
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006542option httpchk
6543option httpchk <uri>
6544option httpchk <method> <uri>
6545option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6546 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6548 yes | no | yes | yes
6549 Arguments :
6550 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6551 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6552 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6553 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6554 ones.
6555
6556 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6557 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6558 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6559
6560 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6561 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6562 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6563 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6564 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6565
6566 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6567 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6568 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6569 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6570 the lack of any response.
6571
6572 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6573
6574 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6575 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6576 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6577
6578 Examples :
6579 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6580 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6581 backend https_relay
6582 mode tcp
6583 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6584 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6585
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006586 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6587 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6588 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006589
6590
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006591option httpclose
6592no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006593 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6595 yes | yes | yes | yes
6596 Arguments : none
6597
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006598 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6599 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6600 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6601 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006602 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006603
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006604 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6605 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006606 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006607 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6608 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006609
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006610 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6611 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6612 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006613
6614 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6615 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006616 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6617 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6618 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006619
6620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6622
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006623 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006624
6625
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006626option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006627 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006629 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006630 Arguments :
6631 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6632 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6633 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006634 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006635 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006636
6637 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6638 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6639 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6640 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6641 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6642 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6643 ports.
6644
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006645 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6646 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006647
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006648 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006650 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006651
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006652
6653option http_proxy
6654no option http_proxy
6655 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | yes | yes | yes
6658 Arguments : none
6659
6660 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6661 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6662 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6663 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6664 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6665
6666 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6667 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006668 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6669 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006670
6671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6673
6674 Example :
6675 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6676 backend direct_forward
6677 option httpclose
6678 option http_proxy
6679
6680 See also : "option httpclose"
6681
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006682
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006683option independent-streams
6684no option independent-streams
6685 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 yes | yes | yes | yes
6688 Arguments : none
6689
6690 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6691 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6692 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6693 receive data or not.
6694
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006695 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006696 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6697 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6698 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6699 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6700 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6701 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6702 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6703 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6704 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6705 socket buffers.
6706
6707 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6708 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6709 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6710 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6711 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6712
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006713 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006714
6715
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006716option ldap-check
6717 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6719 yes | no | yes | yes
6720 Arguments : none
6721
6722 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6723 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6724 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6725 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6726
6727 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6728 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6729
6730 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6731 configure it.
6732
6733 Example :
6734 option ldap-check
6735
6736 See also : "option httpchk"
6737
6738
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006739option external-check
6740 Use external processes for server health checks
6741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6742 yes | no | yes | yes
6743
6744 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6745 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6746 command".
6747
6748 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6749
6750 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6751
6752
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006753option log-health-checks
6754no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006755 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6757 yes | no | yes | yes
6758 Arguments : none
6759
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006760 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6761 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6762 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006763
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006764 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6765 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6766 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6767 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6768 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006770 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006771 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006772
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006773 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6774 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6775 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006776
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006777
6778option log-separate-errors
6779no option log-separate-errors
6780 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6782 yes | yes | yes | no
6783 Arguments : none
6784
6785 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6786 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6787 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6788 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6789 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6790 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6791 provides very important information.
6792
6793 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6794 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6795 error logs.
6796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006797 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006798 logging.
6799
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006800
6801option logasap
6802no option logasap
6803 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6805 yes | yes | yes | no
6806 Arguments : none
6807
6808 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6809 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6810 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6811 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6812 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6813 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6814 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006815 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006816 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6817 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6818
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006819 Examples :
6820 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6821 mode http
6822 option httplog
6823 option logasap
6824 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6825
6826 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6827 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6828 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6829 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006831 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006832 logging.
6833
6834
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006835option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006836 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006839 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006840 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6841 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006842 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006843
6844 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6845 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006846 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006847 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6848 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6849 in the MySQL table, like this :
6850
6851 USE mysql;
6852 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6853 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6854
6855 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006856 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006857 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6858 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6859 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6860 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6861 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6862 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6863 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6864
6865 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6866 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006867
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006868 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006869
6870 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6871 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6872 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6873 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006874 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6875 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006876
6877 See also: "option httpchk"
6878
6879
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006880option nolinger
6881no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006882 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6884 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006885 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006886
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006887 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006888 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6889 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6890 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6891 connections.
6892
6893 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6894 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6895 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6896 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6897 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6898 this too.
6899
6900 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6901 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6902 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6903
6904 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6905 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6906 for servers.
6907
6908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6910
6911
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006912option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6913 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6915 yes | yes | yes | yes
6916 Arguments :
6917 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6918 matching <network>
6919 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6920 header name.
6921
6922 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6923 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6924 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6925 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6926 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6927 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6928 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6929 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6930 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6931 possible that the client has already brought one.
6932
6933 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6934 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6935 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6936 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6937 header and requires different one.
6938
6939 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6940 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6941 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6942 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6943 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6944 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6945 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6946
6947 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6948 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6949 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6950 both are defined.
6951
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006952 Examples :
6953 # Original Destination address
6954 frontend www
6955 mode http
6956 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6957
6958 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6959 backend www
6960 mode http
6961 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6962
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006963 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006964
6965
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006966option persist
6967no option persist
6968 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6970 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006971 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006972
6973 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6974 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6975 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6976 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6977 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6978 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6979 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6980 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6981 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6982 redirected to another valid server.
6983
6984 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6985 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6986
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006987 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006988
6989
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006990option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6991 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6993 yes | no | yes | yes
6994 Arguments :
6995 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6996 PostgreSQL server.
6997
6998 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6999 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7000 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7001 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7002
7003 See also: "option httpchk"
7004
7005
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007006option prefer-last-server
7007no option prefer-last-server
7008 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7010 yes | no | yes | yes
7011 Arguments : none
7012
7013 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7014 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7015 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7016 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7017 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7018 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7019 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7020 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7021 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007022 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7023 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007024 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7025 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7026 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007027 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7028 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7029 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007030
7031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7033
7034 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7035
7036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007037option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007038option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007039no option redispatch
7040 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7042 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007043 Arguments :
7044 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7045 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7046 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007047 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007048 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007049 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007050 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7051 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7052 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007054
7055 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7056 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7057 be able to access the service anymore.
7058
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007059 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7060 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007061
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007062 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007063 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7064 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7068
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007069 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007070
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007071
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007072option redis-check
7073 Use redis health checks for server testing
7074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 yes | no | yes | yes
7076 Arguments : none
7077
7078 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7079 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7080 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7081 find the "+PONG" response message.
7082
7083 Example :
7084 option redis-check
7085
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007086 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007087
7088
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007089option smtpchk
7090option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7091 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7093 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007095 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007096 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007097 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7098
7099 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7100 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7101 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7102
7103 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7104 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7105 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7106 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7107 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7108 dead server.
7109
7110 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7111 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007112 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007113 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7114
7115 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7116 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7117 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7118 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007119 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007120
7121 Example :
7122 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7123
7124 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007127option socket-stats
7128no option socket-stats
7129
7130 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 yes | yes | yes | no
7133
7134 Arguments : none
7135
7136
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007137option splice-auto
7138no option splice-auto
7139 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7141 yes | yes | yes | yes
7142 Arguments : none
7143
7144 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7145 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007146 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007147 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007148 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007149 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7150 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7151 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7152 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7153
7154 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7155 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7156 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7157 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7158 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7159 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7160 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7161 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7162 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7163 keyword.
7164
7165 Example :
7166 option splice-auto
7167
7168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7170
7171 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7172 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7173
7174
7175option splice-request
7176no option splice-request
7177 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7179 yes | yes | yes | yes
7180 Arguments : none
7181
7182 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007183 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007184 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7185 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7186 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7187 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7188
7189 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7190
7191 Example :
7192 option splice-request
7193
7194 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7195 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7196
7197 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7198 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7199
7200
7201option splice-response
7202no option splice-response
7203 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7205 yes | yes | yes | yes
7206 Arguments : none
7207
7208 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007209 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007210 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7211 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7212 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7213 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7214
7215 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7216
7217 Example :
7218 option splice-response
7219
7220 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7221 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7222
7223 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7224 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7225
7226
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007227option spop-check
7228 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7230 no | no | no | yes
7231 Arguments : none
7232
7233 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7234 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7235 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7236 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7237
7238 Example :
7239 option spop-check
7240
7241 See also : "option httpchk"
7242
7243
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007244option srvtcpka
7245no option srvtcpka
7246 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7248 yes | no | yes | yes
7249 Arguments : none
7250
7251 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7252 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007253 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007254 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7255
7256 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7257 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7258 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7259 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7260
7261 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7262 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7263 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7264 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7265 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7266
7267 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7268
7269 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7270 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7271 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7272
7273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7275
7276 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7277
7278
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007279option ssl-hello-chk
7280 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7282 yes | no | yes | yes
7283 Arguments : none
7284
7285 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7286 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7287 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7288 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7289 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7290 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7291 hello message.
7292
7293 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7294 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7295 messages, which is appreciable.
7296
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007297 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7298 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7299 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007300
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007301 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7302
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007303
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007304option tcp-check
7305 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7307 yes | no | yes | yes
7308
7309 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7310 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7311
7312 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7313 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7314 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7315
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007316 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007317 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7318 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7319 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7320 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7321 only.
7322
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007323 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007324 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7325 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7326 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7327 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7328
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007329 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007330 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7331 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007332 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007333 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7334 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7335 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7336 the respective protocols.
7337 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007338 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007339
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007340 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7341 script.
7342
7343 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7344 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7345 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7346 The "comment" is of course optional.
7347
7348
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007349 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007350 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007351 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007352 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007354 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007355 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007356 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007357
7358 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7359 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007360 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007361 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007362 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007363 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007364 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007365 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007366 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7367 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007368 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007369 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7370 tcp-check expect string +OK
7371
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007372 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007373 (send many headers before analyzing)
7374 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007375 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007376 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7377 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7378 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7379 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007380 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007381
7382
7383 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7384
7385
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007386option tcp-smart-accept
7387no option tcp-smart-accept
7388 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 yes | yes | yes | no
7391 Arguments : none
7392
7393 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7394 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7395 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7396 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7397 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7398 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7399
7400 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7401 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7402 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7403 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7404
7405 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7406 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7407 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007408 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007409
7410 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7411 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7412 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7413
7414 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7415 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7416 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7417
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007418 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7419
7420
7421option tcp-smart-connect
7422no option tcp-smart-connect
7423 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7425 yes | no | yes | yes
7426 Arguments : none
7427
7428 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7429 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7430 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7431 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7432 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7433
7434 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7435 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7436 complex.
7437
7438 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7439 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7440 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7441
7442 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7443 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7444
7445 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7446
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007447
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007448option tcpka
7449 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7451 yes | yes | yes | yes
7452 Arguments : none
7453
7454 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7455 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007456 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007457 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7458
7459 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7460 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7461 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7462 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7463
7464 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7465 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7466 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7467 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7468 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7469
7470 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7471
7472 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7473 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7474 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7475 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7476 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7477 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7478 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7479 backends.
7480
7481 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7482
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007483
7484option tcplog
7485 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007487 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007488 Arguments : none
7489
7490 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7491 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7492 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7493 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7494 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7495 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7496 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7497 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7498
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007499 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007501 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007502
7503
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007504option transparent
7505no option transparent
7506 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007508 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007509 Arguments : none
7510
7511 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7512 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7513 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7514 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7515 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7516 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7517 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7518 appropriate server.
7519
7520 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7521 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7522
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007523 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007524 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007525
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007526
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007527external-check command <command>
7528 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7530 yes | no | yes | yes
7531
7532 Arguments :
7533 <command> is the external command to run
7534
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007535 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7536
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007537 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007538
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007539 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7540 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7541 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7542 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7543 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7544 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007545
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007546 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7547
7548 Environment variables :
7549 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7550 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7551
7552 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7553
7554 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7555
7556 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7557 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7558 for a UNIX socket).
7559
7560 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7561
7562 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7563
7564 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7565
7566 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7567
7568 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7569
7570 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7571 socket).
7572
7573 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7574 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7575
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007576 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7577
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007578 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7579 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7580 failed.
7581
7582 Example :
7583 external-check command /bin/true
7584
7585 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7586
7587
7588external-check path <path>
7589 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7591 yes | no | yes | yes
7592
7593 Arguments :
7594 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7595
7596 The default path is "".
7597
7598 Example :
7599 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7600
7601 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7602 "external-check command"
7603
7604
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007605persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007606persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007607 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7609 yes | no | yes | yes
7610 Arguments :
7611 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007612 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7613 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007614
7615 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7616 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007617 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007618 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7619 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7620 forwarded to this server.
7621
7622 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7623 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7624 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007625 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007626 a single "listen" section.
7627
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007628 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7629 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7630 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7631
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007632 Example :
7633 listen tse-farm
7634 bind :3389
7635 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7636 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7637 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7638 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7639 persist rdp-cookie
7640 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007641 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007642 balance rdp-cookie
7643 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7644 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7645
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007646 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7647 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007648
7649
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007650rate-limit sessions <rate>
7651 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 yes | yes | yes | no
7654 Arguments :
7655 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7656 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7657
7658 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7659 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7660 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7661 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7662 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7663 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7664
7665 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7666 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7667 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7668 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7669
7670 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7671 listen smtp
7672 mode tcp
7673 bind :25
7674 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007675 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007676
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007677 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7678 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7679 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007680
7681 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7682
7683
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007684redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7685redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7686redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007687 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7689 no | yes | yes | yes
7690
7691 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007692 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007693
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007694 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007695 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007696 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7697 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7698 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007699
7700 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7701 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7702 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7703 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7704 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007705 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7706 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7707 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7708 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007709
7710 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7711 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7712 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7713 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7714 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7715 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007716 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007717 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007718 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7719 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7720 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007721
7722 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007723 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7724 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7725 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007726 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007727 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7728 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7729 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7730 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007731
7732 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007733 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007734
7735 - "drop-query"
7736 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7737 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7738 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7739 with a location-type redirect.
7740
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007741 - "append-slash"
7742 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7743 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7744 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7745 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7746
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007747 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7748 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7749 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7750 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7751 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7752 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7753 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7754
7755 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7756 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7757 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7758 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7759 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7760 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7761 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007762
7763 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7764 acl clear dst_port 80
7765 acl secure dst_port 8080
7766 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007767 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007768 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007769 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7770
7771 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007772 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7773 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7774 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007775 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007776
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007777 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7778 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7779 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7780
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007781 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007782 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007783
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007784 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007785 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7786 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7787 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007789 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007790
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007791
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007792retries <value>
7793 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 yes | no | yes | yes
7796 Arguments :
7797 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7798 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7799 default value is 3.
7800
7801 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7802 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7803 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7804
7805 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007806 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7807 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007808
7809 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7810 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7811
7812 See also : "option redispatch"
7813
7814
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007815retry-on [list of keywords]
7816 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7818 yes | no | yes | yes
7819 Arguments :
7820 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7821 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7822 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7823 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7824
7825 none never retry
7826
7827 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7828 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7829
7830 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7831 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7832 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7833 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7834 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7835 processing the request.
7836
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007837 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7838 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7839 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7840 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7841 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7842 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7843 overflow attack for example).
7844
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007845 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7846 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7847 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7848 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7849 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7850 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7851 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7852 amplify denial of service attacks.
7853
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007854 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7855 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7856 considered to be safe to retry.
7857
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007858 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7859 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7860 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7861 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7862
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007863 all-retryable-errors
7864 retry request for any error that are considered
7865 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7866 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7867 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7868
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007869 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7870 not cumulative.
7871
7872 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7873 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7874 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7875 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7876
7877 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7878 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7879 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7880 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7881 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7882 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7883 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7884 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7885 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7886 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7887 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7888 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7889
7890 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7891 should not use this directive.
7892
7893 The default is "conn-failure".
7894
7895 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7896
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007897server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007898 Declare a server in a backend
7899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 no | no | yes | yes
7901 Arguments :
7902 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007903 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007904 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007905
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007906 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7907 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7908 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7909 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007910 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7911 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7912 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7913 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7914 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007915 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7916 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7917 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7918 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7919 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7920 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7921 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007922 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007923 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7924 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7925 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7926 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7927 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7928 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007929 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7930 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007931 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7932 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007933
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007934 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007935 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7936 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7937 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7938 adding this value to the client's port.
7939
7940 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7941 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007942 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007943
7944 Examples :
7945 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7946 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007947 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007948 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7949 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7950 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007951
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007952 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7953 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7954 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7955 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7956 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7957
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007958 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7959 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007960
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007961server-state-file-name [<file>]
7962 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7963 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7964 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7965 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7966 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7967 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7968
7969 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7970 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7971
7972 global
7973 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7974
7975 backend bk
7976 load-server-state-from-file
7977
7978 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7979 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007980
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007981server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7982 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7983 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7985 no | no | yes | yes
7986
7987 Arguments:
7988 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7989
7990 <num | range>
7991 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7992 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7993 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7994 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7995
7996 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7997
7998 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7999
8000 <params*>
8001 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8002 keyword.
8003
8004 Examples:
8005 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8006 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8007 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8008
8009 # or
8010 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8011
8012 # would be equivalent to:
8013 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8014 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8015 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8016
8017
8018
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008019source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008020source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008021source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008022 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 yes | no | yes | yes
8025 Arguments :
8026 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8027 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008028
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008029 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008030 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8031 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8032 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8033 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8034 supported prefixes are :
8035 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8036 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8037 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008038 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008039 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8040 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008041
8042 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8043 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008044 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8045 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8046 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008047
8048 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8049 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8050 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8051 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8052 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8053 <addr>.
8054
8055 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8056 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8057 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8058 port.
8059
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008060 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8061 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8062 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8063 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008064 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008065 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8066 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8067 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8068 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8069 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8070 HTTP header.
8071
8072 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8073 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008074 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008075 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8076 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8077 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8078 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8079 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8080 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8081 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8082
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008083 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8084 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8085 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8086 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8087 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8088 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8089
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008090 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8091 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8092 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8093 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8094
8095 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8096 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8097 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8098 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8099 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8100 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8101
8102 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8103 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8104 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8105 there are two methods :
8106
8107 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8108 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8109 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8110 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8111 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8112 of the client ranges may be used.
8113
8114 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8115 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8116 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8117 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8118 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8119 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8120 same session.
8121
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008122 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8123 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8124 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008125 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008126
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008127 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8128
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008129 Examples :
8130 backend private
8131 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8132 source 192.168.1.200
8133
8134 backend transparent_ssl1
8135 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8136 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8137
8138 backend transparent_ssl2
8139 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8140 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8141 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8142
8143 backend transparent_ssl3
8144 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8145 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8146 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8147
8148 backend transparent_smtp
8149 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8150 # with Tproxy version 4.
8151 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8152
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008153 backend transparent_http
8154 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8155 # proxy.
8156 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008158 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008159 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8160
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008161
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008162stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8163 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008165 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008166
8167 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8168 matched.
8169
8170 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8171 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8172
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008173 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8174 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008175 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008176
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008177 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8178 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8179 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8180 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008181
8182 Example :
8183 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8184 backend stats_localhost
8185 stats enable
8186 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8187
8188 Example :
8189 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8190 backend stats_auth
8191 stats enable
8192 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8193 stats admin if TRUE
8194
8195 Example :
8196 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8197 userlist stats-auth
8198 group admin users admin
8199 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8200 group readonly users haproxy
8201 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8202
8203 backend stats_auth
8204 stats enable
8205 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8206 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8207 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8208 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8209
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008210 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8211 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8212 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008213
8214
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008215stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8216 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008218 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008219 Arguments :
8220 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8221
8222 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8223
8224 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8225 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8226 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8227 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8228 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8229 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8230
8231 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8232 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8233 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008234 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008235
8236 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8237 report using "stats scope".
8238
8239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8241 unobvious parameters.
8242
8243 Example :
8244 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8245 backend public_www
8246 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8247 stats enable
8248 stats hide-version
8249 stats scope .
8250 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008251 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008252 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8253 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8254
8255 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8256 backend private_monitoring
8257 stats enable
8258 stats uri /admin?stats
8259 stats refresh 5s
8260
8261 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8262
8263
8264stats enable
8265 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008267 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008268 Arguments : none
8269
8270 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8271 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8272 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8273 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8274 - stats auth : no authentication
8275 - stats scope : no restriction
8276
8277 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8278 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8279 unobvious parameters.
8280
8281 Example :
8282 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8283 backend public_www
8284 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8285 stats enable
8286 stats hide-version
8287 stats scope .
8288 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008289 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008290 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8291 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8292
8293 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8294 backend private_monitoring
8295 stats enable
8296 stats uri /admin?stats
8297 stats refresh 5s
8298
8299 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8300
8301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008302stats hide-version
8303 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008305 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008306 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008307
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008308 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8309 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8310 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8311 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8312 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8313 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008315 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8316 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8317 unobvious parameters.
8318
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008319 Example :
8320 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8321 backend public_www
8322 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008323 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008324 stats hide-version
8325 stats scope .
8326 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008327 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008328 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8329 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008330
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008331 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8332 backend private_monitoring
8333 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008334 stats uri /admin?stats
8335 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008336
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008337 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008338
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008339
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008340stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8341 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8342 Access control for statistics
8343
8344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 no | no | yes | yes
8346
8347 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8348 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8349 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8350 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8351 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8352 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8353
8354 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8355 instance.
8356
8357 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8358 about ACL usage.
8359
8360
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008361stats realm <realm>
8362 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008364 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008365 Arguments :
8366 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8367 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8368 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8369
8370 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8371 using a backslash ('\').
8372
8373 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8374 only related to authentication.
8375
8376 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8377 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8378 unobvious parameters.
8379
8380 Example :
8381 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8382 backend public_www
8383 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8384 stats enable
8385 stats hide-version
8386 stats scope .
8387 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008388 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008389 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8390 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8391
8392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8393 backend private_monitoring
8394 stats enable
8395 stats uri /admin?stats
8396 stats refresh 5s
8397
8398 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8399
8400
8401stats refresh <delay>
8402 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008404 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008405 Arguments :
8406 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8407 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8408 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8409 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8410 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8411 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8412
8413 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8414 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8415 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8416 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8417
8418 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8419 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8420 unobvious parameters.
8421
8422 Example :
8423 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8424 backend public_www
8425 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8426 stats enable
8427 stats hide-version
8428 stats scope .
8429 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008430 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008431 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8432 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8433
8434 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8435 backend private_monitoring
8436 stats enable
8437 stats uri /admin?stats
8438 stats refresh 5s
8439
8440 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8441
8442
8443stats scope { <name> | "." }
8444 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008446 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008447 Arguments :
8448 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8449 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8450 section in which the statement appears.
8451
8452 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8453 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8454 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8455 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8456 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8457 exists.
8458
8459 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8460 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8461 unobvious parameters.
8462
8463 Example :
8464 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8465 backend public_www
8466 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8467 stats enable
8468 stats hide-version
8469 stats scope .
8470 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008471 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008472 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8473 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8474
8475 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8476 backend private_monitoring
8477 stats enable
8478 stats uri /admin?stats
8479 stats refresh 5s
8480
8481 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8482
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008483
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008484stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008485 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008487 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008488
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008489 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008490 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8491
8492 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8493 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8494
8495 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8496 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008497 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008498
8499 Example :
8500 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8501 backend private_monitoring
8502 stats enable
8503 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8504 stats uri /admin?stats
8505 stats refresh 5s
8506
8507 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8508 global section.
8509
8510
8511stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008512 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8514 yes | yes | yes | yes
8515 Arguments : none
8516
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008517 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008518 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8519 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8520 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8521 - IP (socket, server)
8522 - cookie (backend, server)
8523
8524 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8525 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008526 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008527
8528 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8529
8530
8531stats show-node [ <name> ]
8532 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008534 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008535 Arguments:
8536 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8537 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8538
8539 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8540 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008541 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008542
8543 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8544 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8545 unobvious parameters.
8546
8547 Example:
8548 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8549 backend private_monitoring
8550 stats enable
8551 stats show-node Europe-1
8552 stats uri /admin?stats
8553 stats refresh 5s
8554
8555 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8556 section.
8557
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008558
8559stats uri <prefix>
8560 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008562 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008563 Arguments :
8564 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8565 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8566 query string.
8567
8568 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8569 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8570 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8571 possible to reach it in the application.
8572
8573 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008574 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008575 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8576 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8577 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8578 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8579
8580 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8581 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8582 an address or a port to statistics only.
8583
8584 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8585 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8586 unobvious parameters.
8587
8588 Example :
8589 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8590 backend public_www
8591 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8592 stats enable
8593 stats hide-version
8594 stats scope .
8595 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008596 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008597 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8598 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8599
8600 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8601 backend private_monitoring
8602 stats enable
8603 stats uri /admin?stats
8604 stats refresh 5s
8605
8606 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8607
8608
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008609stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8610 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008612 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008613
8614 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008615 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008616 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008617 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008618 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8619
8620 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8621 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8622 the "stick-table" statement.
8623
8624 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8625 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8626 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8627 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8628 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8629
8630 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8631 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8632 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8633 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8634 transformation rules.
8635
8636 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8637 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8638 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8639 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8640 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8641 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8642 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8643
8644 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8645 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8646 ACL based conditions.
8647
8648 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8649 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8650 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8651 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8652
8653 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8654 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8655 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8656 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8657
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008658 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8659 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008660 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008661
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008662 Example :
8663 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8664 # last 30 minutes
8665 backend pop
8666 mode tcp
8667 balance roundrobin
8668 stick store-request src
8669 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8670 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8671 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8672
8673 backend smtp
8674 mode tcp
8675 balance roundrobin
8676 stick match src table pop
8677 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8678 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8679
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008680 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008681 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008682
8683
8684stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8685 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8687 no | no | yes | yes
8688
8689 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8690 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8691 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8692 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8693
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008694 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8695 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008696 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008697
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008698 Examples :
8699 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008700 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008701
8702 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8703 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8704 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8705
8706
8707 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8708 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8709 backend http
8710 mode http
8711 balance roundrobin
8712 stick on src table https
8713 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8714 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8715 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8716
8717 backend https
8718 mode tcp
8719 balance roundrobin
8720 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8721 stick on src
8722 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8723 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8724
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008725 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008726
8727
8728stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8729 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8731 no | no | yes | yes
8732
8733 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008734 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008735 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008736 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008737 server is selected.
8738
8739 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8740 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8741 the "stick-table" statement.
8742
8743 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8744 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8745 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8746 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8747 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8748 address.
8749
8750 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8751 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8752 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8753 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8754 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8755 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8756 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8757 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8758 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8759 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8760
8761 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8762 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8763 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8764 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8765 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8766 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8767 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8768
8769 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8770 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8771 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8772 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8773
8774 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8775 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8776 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8777 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8778 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8779 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008780 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8781 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8782 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8783 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8784 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8785 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008786
8787 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8788 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8789 the request.
8790
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008791 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8792 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008793 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008794
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008795 Example :
8796 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8797 # last 30 minutes
8798 backend pop
8799 mode tcp
8800 balance roundrobin
8801 stick store-request src
8802 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8803 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8804 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8805
8806 backend smtp
8807 mode tcp
8808 balance roundrobin
8809 stick match src table pop
8810 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8811 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8812
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008813 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008814 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008815
8816
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008817stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008818 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8819 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008820 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008822 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008823
8824 Arguments :
8825 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8826 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8827 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8828 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8829
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008830 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8831 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8832 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8833 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8834
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008835 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8836 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8837 instance.
8838
8839 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8840 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8841 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8842 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8843 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8844 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008845 to 32 characters.
8846
8847 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8848 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8849 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008850 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008851 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8852 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008853
8854 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008855 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8856 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008857 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8858 increase.
8859
8860 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008861 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8862 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8863 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008864
8865 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8866 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8867 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8868 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008869 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008870 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8871 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8872 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8873 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8874 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8875 parameter (see below).
8876
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008877 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8878 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8879 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8880 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8881 soft restart.
8882
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008883 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8884 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008885
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008886 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8887 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8888 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8889 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008890 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008891 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008892 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8893 if not expiration delay is specified.
8894
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008895 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8896 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8897 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8898 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008899 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8900 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8901 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8902 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8903 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8904 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8905 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8906 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8907 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8908 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8909 types and their arguments.
8910
8911 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8912 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8913 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8914 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8915
8916 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8917 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8918 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008919 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008920
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008921 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8922 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8923 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008924 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008925 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008926 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008927
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008928 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8929 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8930 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8931 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8932
8933 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8934 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8935 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8936 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8937 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8938 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8939
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008940 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8941 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8942 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8943 they were received.
8944
8945 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8946 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8947 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8948 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8949 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8950
8951 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8952 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8953 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8954 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8955 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8956
8957 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8958 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8959 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8960
8961 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8962 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8963 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8964 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8965 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8966
8967 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8968 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8969 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8970 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8971 the client side.
8972
8973 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8974 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8975 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8976 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8977 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8978 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8979 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8980
8981 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8982 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8983 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8984 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8985 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8986 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008987 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008988
8989 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8990 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8991 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8992 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8993 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8994 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8995
8996 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008997 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008998 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8999 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9000
9001 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9002 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9003 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9004 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9005 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9006 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9007 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9008 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9009 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9010 recommended for better fairness.
9011
9012 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009013 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009014 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9015 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9016
9017 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9018 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9019 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9020 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9021 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9022 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9023 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9024 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9025 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9026 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009027
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009028 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9029 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009030 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9031 reference it.
9032
9033 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9034 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009035 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9036 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9037 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009038
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009039 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9040 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9041 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9042 something that can be ignored.
9043
9044 Example:
9045 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9046 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9047 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9048 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9049
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009050 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009051 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009052
9053
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009054stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009055 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9057 no | no | yes | yes
9058
9059 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009060 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009061 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009062 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009063 server is selected.
9064
9065 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9066 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9067 the "stick-table" statement.
9068
9069 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9070 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9071 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9072 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9073
9074 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9075 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9076 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9077 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9078 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9079 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009080 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009081 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9082 rules.
9083
9084 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9085 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9086 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9087 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9088 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9089 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9090 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9091
9092 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9093 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9094 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9095 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9096
9097 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9098 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9099 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9100 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9101 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9102 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009103 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9104 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9105 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9106 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9107 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9108 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9109 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9110 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9111 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009112
9113 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9114
9115 Example :
9116 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9117 backend https
9118 mode tcp
9119 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009120 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009121 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009122
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009123 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9124 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9125
9126 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9127 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9128 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9129
9130 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9131 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009132
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009133 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9134 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9135 # at offset 44.
9136
9137 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9138 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9139
9140 # Learn on response if server hello.
9141 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009142
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009143 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9144 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9145
9146 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9147 extraction.
9148
9149
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009150tcp-check connect [params*]
9151 Opens a new connection
9152 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9153 no | no | yes | yes
9154
9155 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9156 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9157 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9158
9159 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9160 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9161 of the sequence.
9162
9163 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9164 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9165 do.
9166
9167 Parameters :
9168 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9169 use the TCP connection.
9170
9171 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9172 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9173 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9174
9175 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9176
9177 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9178
9179 Examples:
9180 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9181 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9182 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9183 option tcp-check
9184 tcp-check connect
9185 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9186 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9187 tcp-check send \r\n
9188 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9189 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9190 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9191 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9192 tcp-check send \r\n
9193 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9194 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9195
9196 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9197 option tcp-check
9198 tcp-check connect port 110
9199 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9200 tcp-check connect port 143
9201 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9202 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9203
9204 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9205
9206
9207tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009208 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 no | no | yes | yes
9211
9212 Arguments :
9213 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9214 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9215 binary.
9216 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9217 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9218 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9219
9220 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9221 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9222 with the usual backslash ('\').
9223 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009224 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009225 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9226 used upper or lower case.
9227
9228
9229 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9230
9231 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9232 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9233 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9234 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9235 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9236 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9237 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9238 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9239
9240 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9241 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9242 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9243 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9244 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9245 expression.
9246
9247 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9248 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9249 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9250 this exact hexadecimal string.
9251 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9252
9253 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9254 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9255 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9256 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9257 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9258 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9259 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9260 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9261 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9262 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9263 the null character.
9264
9265 Examples :
9266 # perform a POP check
9267 option tcp-check
9268 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9269
9270 # perform an IMAP check
9271 option tcp-check
9272 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9273
9274 # look for the redis master server
9275 option tcp-check
9276 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009277 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009278 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9279 tcp-check expect string role:master
9280 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9281 tcp-check expect string +OK
9282
9283
9284 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9285 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9286
9287
9288tcp-check send <data>
9289 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9291 no | no | yes | yes
9292
9293 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9294 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9295
9296 Examples :
9297 # look for the redis master server
9298 option tcp-check
9299 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9300 tcp-check expect string role:master
9301
9302 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9303 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9304
9305
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009306tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9307 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009308 tcp health check
9309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9310 no | no | yes | yes
9311
9312 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9313 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009314 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009315 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9316 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9317 hexadecimal string.
9318 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9319
9320 Examples :
9321 # redis check in binary
9322 option tcp-check
9323 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9324 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9325
9326
9327 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9328 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9329
9330
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009331tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9332 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9334 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009336 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9337 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009339 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009340
9341 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9342 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009343 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9344 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9345 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9346 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9347 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9348 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009349
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009350 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9351 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9352 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9353 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009354
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009355 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009356 - accept :
9357 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9358 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9359 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009360
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009361 - reject :
9362 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9363 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9364 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9365 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9366 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9367 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9368 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9369 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9370 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9371 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9372 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009373 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009374
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009375 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9376 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9377 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9378 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9379 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9380 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9381 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9382 hosts.
9383
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009384 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9385 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9386 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9387 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9388 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9389 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9390 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9391 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9392
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009393 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9394 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9395 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9396 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9397 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9398 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9399 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9400 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9401 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009402 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9403 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009404
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009405 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009406 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009407 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9408 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9409 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009410 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009411 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9412 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9413 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9414 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9415 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9416 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9417 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9418 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009420 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009421 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009422 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009423 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009424 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9425 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9426 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009427
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009428 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9429 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9430 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9431 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009432
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009433 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9434 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9435 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9436 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9437 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009438 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9439 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9440 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9441 layer7 information is extracted.
9442
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009443 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9444 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9445 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9446 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9447 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009448
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009449 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9450 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9451 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9452 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9453
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009454 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9455 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9456 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9457 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9458
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009459 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9460 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9461 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9462 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9463 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009464
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009465 - set-src <expr> :
9466 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9467 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9468 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009469 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009470
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009471 Arguments:
9472 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9473 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009474
9475 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009476 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9477
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009478 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9479 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009480
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009481 - set-src-port <expr> :
9482 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9483 expression.
9484
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009485 Arguments:
9486 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9487 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009488
9489 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009490 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9491
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009492 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9493 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9494 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009495
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009496 - set-dst <expr> :
9497 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9498 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9499 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9500 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9501 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9502
9503 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9504 followed by some converters.
9505
9506 Example:
9507
9508 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9509 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9510
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009511 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9512 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9513
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009514 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9515 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9516 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9517 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9518
9519
9520 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9521 followed by some converters.
9522
9523 Example:
9524
9525 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9526
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009527 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9528 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9529 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9530
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009531 - "silent-drop" :
9532 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009533 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009534 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9535 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9536 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9537 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9538 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009539 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9540 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009541 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9542 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009543 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009544 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9545 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9546 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9547 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009549 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9550 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9551 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009553 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9554 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9555 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009557 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009558 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009559 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009560
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009561 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9562 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9563 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009564
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009565 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009566 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9567 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009568
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009569 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9570
9571 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9572
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009573 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9574
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009575 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009576
9577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009578tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9579 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009581 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009582 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009583 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9584 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009585
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009586 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009587
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009588 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009589 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9590 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9591 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9592 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009594 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9595 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9596 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9597 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009598 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9599 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9600 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9601 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9602 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9603 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009604 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009605 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009607 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9608 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9609 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9610 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009611
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009612 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009613 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009614 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009615 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9616 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009617 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009618 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009619 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009620 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009621 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009622 - set-dst <expr>
9623 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009624 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009625 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009626 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009627 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009628 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009629
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009630 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9631 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009632 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9633 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009634
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009635 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9636 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9637 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9638 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9639 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9640 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009642 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009643 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9644 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009646 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009647 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9648 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9649 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9650 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009651 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9652 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9653 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009654
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009655 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009656 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9657 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9658 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009659
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009660 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9661 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9662
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009663 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009664 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9665 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009666
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009667 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9668 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009669 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009670 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9671 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009672 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009673 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009674 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9676 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009677 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009678 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9679 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009680
9681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9682 followed by some converters.
9683
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009684 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9685 <var-name>.
9686
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009687 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9688 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9689 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9690 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9691 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9692
9693 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9694 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9695 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9696 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9697 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9698 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9699 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9700 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9701 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9702 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9703 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9704
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009705 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9706 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9707 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9708 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9709 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9710
9711 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9712
9713 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9714
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009715 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9716 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9717 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9718 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9719 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9720 evaluated.
9721
9722 Example:
9723 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9724
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009725 Example:
9726
9727 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009728 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009729
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009730 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009731 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9732 # and reject everything else.
9733 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9734 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009735 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009736 tcp-request content reject
9737
9738 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009739 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9740 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9741 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009742 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009743
9744 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9745 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9746 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009747 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009748 tcp-request content reject
9749
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009750 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009751 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009752 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009753 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009754 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9755 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009756
9757 Example:
9758 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9759 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009760 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009761
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009762 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009763 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009764
9765 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009767 # protecting all our sites
9768 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009769 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9770 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771 ...
9772 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9773
9774 backend http_dynamic
9775 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009776 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009777 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009778 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009779 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009780 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009781 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009783 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009784
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009785 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9786 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009787
9788
9789tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9790 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009792 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009793 Arguments :
9794 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9795 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9796 as explained at the top of this document.
9797
9798 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9799 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9800 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9801 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9802 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9803
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009804 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9805 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9806 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9807 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9808
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009809 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9810 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009811 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009812 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009813 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9814 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9815 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9816 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009817
9818 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9819 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9820 it pass through unaffected.
9821
9822 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9823 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9824 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009825 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009826 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9827 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009828 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9829 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9830 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009831
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009832 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009833 "timeout client".
9834
9835
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009836tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9837 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9839 no | no | yes | yes
9840 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009841 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9842 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009843
9844 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9845
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009846 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009847 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9848 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009849 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9850 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009851
9852 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9853
9854 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9855 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9856 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9857 inserted.
9858
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009859 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009860 - accept :
9861 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9862 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9863 the rules evaluation.
9864
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009865 - close :
9866 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9867 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9868 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9869 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9870 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9871 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009872 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009873 protocols.
9874
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009875 - reject :
9876 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9877 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009878 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009879
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009880 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9881 Sets a variable.
9882
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009883 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9884 Unsets a variable.
9885
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009886 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9887 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9888 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9889 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9890
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009891 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9892 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9893 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9894 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9895
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009896 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
9897 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9898 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9899 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9900 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009901
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009902 - "silent-drop" :
9903 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009904 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009905 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9906 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9907 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9908 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9909 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009910 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9911 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009912 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9913 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009914 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009915 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9916 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9917 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9918 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9919
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009920 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9921 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9922
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009923 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9924 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9925 for changing the default action to a reject.
9926
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009927 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9928 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9929 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9930 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009931 period.
9932
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009933 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9934 declared inline.
9935
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009936 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9937 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009938 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009939 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9940 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009941 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009942 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009943 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009944 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9945 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009946 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009947 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9948 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009949
9950 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9951 followed by some converters.
9952
9953 Example:
9954
9955 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9956
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009957 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9958 <var-name>.
9959
9960 Example:
9961
9962 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9963
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009964 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9965 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9966 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9967 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9968 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9969
9970 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9971
9972 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9973
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009974 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9975
9976 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9977
9978
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009979tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9980 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9982 no | yes | yes | no
9983 Arguments :
9984 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9985 below.
9986
9987 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9988
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009989 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009990 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9991 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9992 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9993 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9994 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9995 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9996 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009997 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009998 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9999 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10000 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10001 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10002 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10003 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10004 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10005 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10006 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10007 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10008 instead.
10009
10010 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10011 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10012 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10013 rules which may be inserted.
10014
10015 Several types of actions are supported :
10016 - accept : the request is accepted
10017 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10018 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10019 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010020 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010021 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010022 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010023 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010024 - silent-drop
10025
10026 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10027 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10028 sections for a complete description.
10029
10030 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10031 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10032 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10033
10034 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10035 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10036 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10037 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10038 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10039
10040 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10041 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10042
10043 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10044 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10045 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10046
10047 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10048 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10049 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10050
10051 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10052 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10053 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10054
10055 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10056 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10057 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10058
10059 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10060
10061 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10062
10063
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010064tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10065 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10067 no | no | yes | yes
10068 Arguments :
10069 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10070 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10071 as explained at the top of this document.
10072
10073 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10074
10075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010076timeout check <timeout>
10077 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10078 established.
10079
10080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10081 yes | no | yes | yes
10082 Arguments:
10083 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10085 as explained at the top of this document.
10086
10087 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10088 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010089 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010090 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010091 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10092 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10093 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010094
10095 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10096 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10097
10098 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10099 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010100 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010101
10102 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10103 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10104 forget about it.
10105
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010106 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10107 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010108
10109
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010110timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010111 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10113 yes | yes | yes | no
10114 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010115 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010116 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10117 as explained at the top of this document.
10118
10119 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10120 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10121 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010122 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10123 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10124 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10125 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010126 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10127 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10128 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010129 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010130 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010131 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10132 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010133 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10134 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010135
10136 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10137 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10138 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10139 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010140 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010141 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10142
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010143 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010144
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010145 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010147
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010148timeout client-fin <timeout>
10149 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10151 yes | yes | yes | no
10152 Arguments :
10153 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10154 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10155 as explained at the top of this document.
10156
10157 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10158 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10159 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10160 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10161 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10162 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10163 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010164 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10165 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10166 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010167
10168 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10169 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10170 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10171
10172 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10173
10174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010175timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010176 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10178 yes | no | yes | yes
10179 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010180 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010181 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10182 as explained at the top of this document.
10183
10184 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010185 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010186 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010187 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010188 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10189 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010190
10191 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10192 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10193 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10194 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010195 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010196 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10197
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010198 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010199
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010200
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010201timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10202 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10204 yes | yes | yes | yes
10205 Arguments :
10206 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10208 as explained at the top of this document.
10209
10210 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10211 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10212 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10213 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10214 once the request has started to present itself.
10215
10216 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10217 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10218 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10219 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10220 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10221
10222 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10223 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10224 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10225 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10226
10227 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10228 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010229 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010230 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10231 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010232 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010233
10234 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10235 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10236 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10237 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10238
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010239 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10240 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010241 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10242
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010243 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10244
10245
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010246timeout http-request <timeout>
10247 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010249 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010250 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010251 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010252 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10253 as explained at the top of this document.
10254
10255 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10256 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10257 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10258 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10259 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10260 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10261 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010262 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10263 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10264 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10265 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010266 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010267 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10268 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010269
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010270 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10271 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10272 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10273 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10274 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010275 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010276
10277 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10278 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010279 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010280 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10281 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10282
10283 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010284 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10285 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10286 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010287
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010288 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010289 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010290
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010291
10292timeout queue <timeout>
10293 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10295 yes | no | yes | yes
10296 Arguments :
10297 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10298 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10299 as explained at the top of this document.
10300
10301 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10302 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10303 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10304 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10305 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10306
10307 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10308 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10309 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10310 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10311
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010312 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010313
10314
10315timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010316 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10318 yes | no | yes | yes
10319 Arguments :
10320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10322 as explained at the top of this document.
10323
10324 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10325 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10326 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10327 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10328 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10329 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10330 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10331
10332 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10333 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10334 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10335 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10336 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010337 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010338 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010339 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10340 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010341 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10342 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010343
10344 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10345 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10346 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10347 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010348 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010349 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10350
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010351 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010352
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010353
10354timeout server-fin <timeout>
10355 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10357 yes | no | yes | yes
10358 Arguments :
10359 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10360 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10361 as explained at the top of this document.
10362
10363 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10364 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10365 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10366 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10367 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10368 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10369 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10370 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10371 situations, it should not be needed.
10372
10373 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10374 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10375 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10376
10377 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10378
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010379
10380timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010381 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10383 yes | yes | yes | yes
10384 Arguments :
10385 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10386 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10387 as explained at the top of this document.
10388
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010389 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10390 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10391 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010392
10393 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10394 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10395 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10396 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010397 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010398
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010399 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010400
10401
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010402timeout tunnel <timeout>
10403 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10405 yes | no | yes | yes
10406 Arguments :
10407 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10408 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10409 as explained at the top of this document.
10410
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010411 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010412 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10413 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10414 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010415 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10416 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010417 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10418 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10419 specified.
10420
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010421 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10422 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10423 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10424 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10425 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10426 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10427 state.
10428
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010429 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10430 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10431 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10432 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010433 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010434
10435 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10436 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10437 forget about it.
10438
10439 Example :
10440 defaults http
10441 option http-server-close
10442 timeout connect 5s
10443 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010444 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010445 timeout server 30s
10446 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10447
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010448 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010449
10450
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010451transparent (deprecated)
10452 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010454 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010455 Arguments : none
10456
10457 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10458 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10459 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10460 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10461 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10462 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10463 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10464 appropriate server.
10465
10466 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10467
10468 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10469 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10470
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010471 See also: "option transparent"
10472
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010473unique-id-format <string>
10474 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10476 yes | yes | yes | no
10477 Arguments :
10478 <string> is a log-format string.
10479
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010480 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10481 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10482 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10483 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010484
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010485 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10486 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10487 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10488 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10489 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10490 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10491 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10492 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010493
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010494 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10495 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010496
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010497 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010498
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010499 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010500
10501 will generate:
10502
10503 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10504
10505 See also: "unique-id-header"
10506
10507unique-id-header <name>
10508 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10510 yes | yes | yes | no
10511 Arguments :
10512 <name> is the name of the header.
10513
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010514 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10515 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010516
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010517 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010518
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010519 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010520 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10521
10522 will generate:
10523
10524 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10525
10526 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010527
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010528use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010529 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10531 no | yes | yes | no
10532 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010533 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10534 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010535
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010536 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10537 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010538
10539 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10540 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10541 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010542 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010543 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010544 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10545 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010546
10547 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10548 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10549 assign the backend.
10550
10551 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10552 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10553 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10554 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10555 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10556 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10557
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010558 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010559 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010560 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10561 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10562 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10563
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010564 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10565 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10566 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10567 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10568 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10569 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10570 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10571 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10572 cannot be forced from the request.
10573
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010574 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010575 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10576 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10577
10578 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10579 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010580
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010581use-fcgi-app <name>
10582 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10584 no | no | yes | yes
10585 Arguments :
10586 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10587
10588 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010589
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010590use-server <server> if <condition>
10591use-server <server> unless <condition>
10592 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10594 no | no | yes | yes
10595 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010596 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010597
10598 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10599
10600 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10601 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10602 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10603
10604 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10605 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10606 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10607 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10608 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10609 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10610 matches will assign the server.
10611
10612 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10613 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10614 with the next rules until one matches.
10615
10616 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10617 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10618 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10619 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10620
10621 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10622 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10623 stripped.
10624
10625 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10626 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10627 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10628 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10629
10630 Example :
10631 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10632 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10633 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10634 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10635 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10636 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010637 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010638 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10639 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10640
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010641 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010642
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010643
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106445. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010645--------------------------
10646
10647The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10648depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10649settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10650written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10651described in this section.
10652
10653
106545.1. Bind options
10655-----------------
10656
10657The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10658as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10659no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10660parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10661while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10662provided immediately after the setting name.
10663
10664The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10665
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010666accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10667 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10668 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10669 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10670 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10671 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10672 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10673 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10674 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10675 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010676 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10677 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10678 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010679
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010680accept-proxy
10681 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010682 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10683 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010684 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10685 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10686 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10687 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010688 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010689 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10690 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010691 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10692 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010693
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010694allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010695 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010696 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010697 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010698 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10699 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010700
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010701alpn <protocols>
10702 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10703 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10704 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010705 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010706 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010707 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10708 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10709 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10710 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10711 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10712 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10713 preference, like below :
10714
10715 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010716
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010717backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010718 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010719 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10720
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010721curves <curves>
10722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10723 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10724 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10725 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10726 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10727 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10728
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010729ecdhe <named curve>
10730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010731 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10732 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010733
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010734ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010735 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10736 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10737 client's certificate.
10738
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010739ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10741 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10742 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10743 error is ignored.
10744
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010745ca-sign-file <cafile>
10746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10747 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10748 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10749 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10750 'generate-certificates' for details.
10751
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010752ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10754 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10755 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10756 'generate-certificates' for details.
10757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010758ciphers <ciphers>
10759 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10760 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010761 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010762 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010763 information and recommendations see e.g.
10764 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10765 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10766 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10767
10768ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10770 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10771 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10772 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010773 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10774 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010775
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010776crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10778 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10779 to verify client's certificate.
10780
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010781crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10783 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10784 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10785 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10786 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10787 file.
10788
10789 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10790 are loaded.
10791
10792 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010793 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010794 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10795 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10796 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10797 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010798 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10799 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010800 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010801
10802 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10803 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10804 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10805 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010806 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10807 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010808
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010809 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010810
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010811 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010812 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010813 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10814 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010815 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10816 clients).
10817
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010818 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10819 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10820 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10821 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10822 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10823 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10824 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10825 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10826 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10827 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10828 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10829 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10830 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10831
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010832 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10833 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10834 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10835 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10836 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10837
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010838 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10839 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10840 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10841 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010842
10843 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10844 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10845 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10846 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10847 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10848 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10849 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10850 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10851 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10852
10853 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10854
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010855 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010856 a cert bundle.
10857
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010858 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010859 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10860 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10861 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10862 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10863 provide multi-cert support.
10864
10865 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10866
10867 Filename | CN | SAN
10868 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10869 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010870 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010871 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10872 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10873
10874 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10875 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10876 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10877 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010878 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10879 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10880 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010881
10882 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10883 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10884
10885 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10886 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10887 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10888
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010889crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010891 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010892 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010893 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010894
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010895crt-list <file>
10896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010897 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10898 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010899
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010900 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10901
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010902 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10903 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010904 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010905 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010906
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010907 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10908 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10909 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10910 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10911 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10912 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10913 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10914 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010915
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010916 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010917 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010918 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10919 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10920 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010921
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010922 crt-list file example:
10923 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010924 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010925 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010926 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010927
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010928defer-accept
10929 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10930 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10931 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010932 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010933 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10934 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10935 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10936 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10937 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10938 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10939 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10940
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010941expose-fd listeners
10942 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10943 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010944 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10945 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010947
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010948force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010949 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010950 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010951 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010952 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010953
10954force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010955 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010956 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010957 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010958
10959force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010960 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010961 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010962 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010963
10964force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010965 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010966 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010967 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010968
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010969force-tlsv13
10970 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10971 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010972 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010973
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010974generate-certificates
10975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10976 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10977 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10978 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10979 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10980 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10981 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10982 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10983 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10984 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10985 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10986
10987 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10988 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010989 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010990 certificate is used many times.
10991
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010992gid <gid>
10993 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10994 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10995 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10996 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10997 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10998
10999group <group>
11000 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11001 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11002 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11003 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11004 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11005
11006id <id>
11007 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11008 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11009 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11010 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11011
11012interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011013 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11014 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11015 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11016 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11017 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11018 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011019 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11020 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11021 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11022 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11023 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11024 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011025
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011026level <level>
11027 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11028 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11029 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011030 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011031 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11032 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11033 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011034 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011035 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011036 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011037 all counters).
11038
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011039severity-output <format>
11040 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11041 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11042 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11043 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11044 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11045 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11046 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11047 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11048 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11049 rfc5424 convention.
11050
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011051maxconn <maxconn>
11052 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11053 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11054 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11055 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11056 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11057 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11058 eat all memory.
11059
11060mode <mode>
11061 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11062 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11063 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11064 UNIX sockets.
11065
11066mss <maxseg>
11067 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11068 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11069 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11070 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11071 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11072 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11073 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11074 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11075 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11076 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11077 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11078
11079name <name>
11080 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11081 page.
11082
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011083namespace <name>
11084 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11085 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11086 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11087 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011089nice <nice>
11090 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11091 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11092 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11093 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11094 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11095 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11096 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11097 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11098 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11099 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11100 one for an RDP socket.
11101
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011102no-ca-names
11103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11104 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11105
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011106no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011108 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011109 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011110 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011111 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11112 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011113
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011114no-tls-tickets
11115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11116 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11117 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011118 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11119 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011120
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011121no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011123 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011124 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011125 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011126 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11127 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011128
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011129no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011131 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011132 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011133 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011134 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11135 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011136
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011137no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011139 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011140 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011141 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011142 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11143 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011144
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011145no-tlsv13
11146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11147 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11148 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11149 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011150 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11151 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011152
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011153npn <protocols>
11154 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11155 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11156 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011157 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011158 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011159 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11160 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11161 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11162 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11163 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011164
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011165prefer-client-ciphers
11166 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11167 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11168 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011169 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11170 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11171 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011172
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011173process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011174 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011175 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011176 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011177 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11178 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11179 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11180 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011181 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011182 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11183 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11184 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11185 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11186 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011187
11188 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11189
11190 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11191 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11192 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11193 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11194 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11195 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11196 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11197 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011198
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011199proto <name>
11200 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11201 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11202 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11203 in haproxy -vv.
11204 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11205 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011206 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011207 h2" on the bind line.
11208
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011209ssl
11210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011211 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011212 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11213 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011214 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11215 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011216
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011217ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11218 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11219 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11220 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11221
11222ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11223 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11224 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11225 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11226
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011227strict-sni
11228 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11229 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11230 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11231 See the "crt" option for more information.
11232
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011233tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011234 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011235 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11236 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011237 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011238 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11239 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11240 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11241 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11242 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11243 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11244 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11245
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011246tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011247 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011248 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11249 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11250 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11251 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11252 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11253 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11254 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011255 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11256 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11257 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011258
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011259tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11260 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011261 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11262 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11263 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11264 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11265 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11266 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11267 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11268 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11269 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11270 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011271 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11272 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11273
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011274transparent
11275 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11276 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11277 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11278 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11279 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11280 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11281 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11282 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11283 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11284 so check for support with your vendor.
11285
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011286v4v6
11287 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11288 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11289 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11290 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011291 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011292
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011293v6only
11294 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11295 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11296 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011297 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11298 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011299
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011300uid <uid>
11301 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11302 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11303 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11304 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11305 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11306
11307user <user>
11308 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11309 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11310 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11311 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11312 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11313
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011314verify [none|optional|required]
11315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11316 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11317 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11318 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11319 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011320 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11321 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11322 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11323 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011324
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113255.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011326------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011328The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11329which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11330arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11331settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11332after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11333Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11334address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011336 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011337 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011338
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011339Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11340keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011342The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011343
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011344addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011345 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011346 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11347 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11348 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11349 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11350 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011351
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011352agent-check
11353 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011354 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011355 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11356 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11357 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011358
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011359 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011360 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011361 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11362 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11363 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011365 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11366 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11367 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11368 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11369 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011370
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011371 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011372 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011373
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011374 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11375 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11376 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011377
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011378 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11379 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11380 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011381
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011382 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11383 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11384 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11385 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11386 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011387 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011388 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011389
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011390 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11391 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011392
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011393 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11394 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11395 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11396 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11397 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11398 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11399 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11400 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11401 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011402
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011403 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11404 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011405 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11406 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11407 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011408 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011409
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011410 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011411 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011412
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011413agent-send <string>
11414 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11415 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11416 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11417 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11418 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11419
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011420agent-inter <delay>
11421 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11422 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11423
11424 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11425 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11426 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11427 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11428 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11429 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11430 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11431 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11432 of backends use the same servers.
11433
11434 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11435
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011436agent-addr <addr>
11437 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11438
11439 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11440 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11441 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11442 hostname, it will be resolved.
11443
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011444agent-port <port>
11445 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11446
11447 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11448
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011449allow-0rtt
11450 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011451 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11452 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011453
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011454alpn <protocols>
11455 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11456 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11457 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011458 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011459 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11460 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11461 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11462 now obsolete NPN extension.
11463 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11464 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11465
11466 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011468backup
11469 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11470 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11471 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11472 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011473 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11474 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011475
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011476ca-file <cafile>
11477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11478 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11479 server's certificate.
11480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011481check
11482 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011483 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11484 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11485 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11486 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11487 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11488 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11489 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011490 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11491 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011492 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11493 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011494
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011495check-send-proxy
11496 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11497 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11498 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11499 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11500 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11501 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11502 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11503
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011504check-alpn <protocols>
11505 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11506 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11507 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11508
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011509check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011510 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011511 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11512 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011513
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011514check-ssl
11515 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11516 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11517 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11518 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011519 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011520 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11521 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011522 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011523 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11524 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011525
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011526check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011527 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011528 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11529 for normal traffic.
11530
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011531ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11533 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11534 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011535 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11536 information and recommendations see e.g.
11537 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11538 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11539 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011540
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011541ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11543 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11544 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11545 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011546 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11547 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11548 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011550cookie <value>
11551 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11552 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11553 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11554 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11555 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11556 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11557 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11558
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011559crl-file <crlfile>
11560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11561 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11562 to verify server's certificate.
11563
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011564crt <cert>
11565 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11566 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11567 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11568 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11569 certificate request.
11570
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011571disabled
11572 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11573 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11574 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11575 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11576 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011577 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011578
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011579enabled
11580 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11581 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11582 default value.
11583 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11584 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011586error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011587 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11588 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11589 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011591 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011593fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011594 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11595 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11596 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11597
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011598force-sslv3
11599 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11600 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011601 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011602 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011603
11604force-tlsv10
11605 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011606 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011607 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011608
11609force-tlsv11
11610 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011611 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011612 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011613
11614force-tlsv12
11615 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011616 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011617 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011618
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011619force-tlsv13
11620 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11621 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011622 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011625 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11626 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11627 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011628
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011629init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11630 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11631 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011632 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011633 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11634 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11635 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11636 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11637 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11638 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11639 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11640 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11641 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011642 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011643 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11644 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11645 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11646 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11647 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11648 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011649 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011650
11651 Example:
11652 defaults
11653 # never fail on address resolution
11654 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011656inter <delay>
11657fastinter <delay>
11658downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011659 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11660 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11661 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11662 between checks depending on the server state :
11663
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011664 Server state | Interval used
11665 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11666 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11667 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11668 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11669 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11670 or yet unchecked. |
11671 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11672 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11673 | "inter" otherwise.
11674 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011676 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11677 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11678 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11679 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011680 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11681 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11682 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11683 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11684 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011686maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011687 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11688 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011689 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11690 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011691 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11692 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11693 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11694 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11695
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011696 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11697 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11698 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11699 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11700 than 50 concurrent requests.
11701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011702maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011703 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11704 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11705 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11706 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11707 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11708 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11709 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11710
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011711max-reuse <count>
11712 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11713 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11714 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11715 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11716 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11717 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11718 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11719 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011721minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011722 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11723 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11724 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11725 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11726 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11727 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011728 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011729 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011730
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011731namespace <name>
11732 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11733 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11734 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11735 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11736
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011737no-agent-check
11738 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11739 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11740 default value.
11741 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11742 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11743
11744no-backup
11745 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11746 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11747 default value.
11748 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11749 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11750
11751no-check
11752 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11753 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11754 default value.
11755 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11756 "default-server" "check" setting.
11757
11758no-check-ssl
11759 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11760 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11761 default value.
11762 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11763 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11764
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011765no-send-proxy
11766 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11767 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11768 default value.
11769 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11770 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11771
11772no-send-proxy-v2
11773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11775 default value.
11776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11777 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11778
11779no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11782 default value.
11783 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11784 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11785
11786no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11787 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11788 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11789 default value.
11790 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11791 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11792
11793no-ssl
11794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11796 default value.
11797 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11798 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11799
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011800no-ssl-reuse
11801 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11802 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11803 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11804 and for paranoid users.
11805
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011806no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011807 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11808 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011809 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011810
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011811 Supported in default-server: No
11812
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011813no-tls-tickets
11814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11815 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11816 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011817 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11818 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011819 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011820
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011821no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011822 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011823 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11824 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011825 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11826 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011827 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011828
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011829 Supported in default-server: No
11830
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011831no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011832 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011833 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11834 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011835 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11836 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011837 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011838
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011839 Supported in default-server: No
11840
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011841no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011842 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011843 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11844 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011845 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11846 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011847 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011848
11849 Supported in default-server: No
11850
11851no-tlsv13
11852 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11853 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11854 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11855 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11856 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011857 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011858
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011859 Supported in default-server: No
11860
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011861no-verifyhost
11862 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11863 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11864 default value.
11865 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11866 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011867
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011868no-tfo
11869 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11870 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11871 default value.
11872 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11873 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11874
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011875non-stick
11876 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11877 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11878 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11879
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011880npn <protocols>
11881 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11882 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11883 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011884 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011885 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11886 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11887 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011889observe <mode>
11890 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11891 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11892 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11893 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11894 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11895 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011896 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011897
11898 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011900on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011901 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11902 Currently, four modes are available:
11903 - fastinter: force fastinter
11904 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11905 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11906 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11907 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11908
11909 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11910
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011911on-marked-down <action>
11912 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11913 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011914 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11915 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11916 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11917 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11918 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11919 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11920 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11921 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011922
11923 Actions are disabled by default
11924
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011925on-marked-up <action>
11926 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11927 Currently one action is available:
11928 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11929 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11930 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11931 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011932 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11933 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011934 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11935 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11936
11937 Actions are disabled by default
11938
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011939pool-max-conn <max>
11940 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11941 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11942 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11943 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11944 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11945 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11946
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011947pool-purge-delay <delay>
11948 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011949 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011950 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011952port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011953 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11954 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11955 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11956 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11957 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11958 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11959
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011960proto <name>
11961
11962 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11963 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11964 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11965 reported in haproxy -vv.
11966 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11967 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011969redir <prefix>
11970 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11971 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11972 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11973 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11974 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11975 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11976 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11977 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011978 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011979 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011980 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11981 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11982 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11983 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11984
11985 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011987rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011988 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11989 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11990 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11991
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011992resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11993 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11994 server.
11995
11996 Available options:
11997
11998 * allow-dup-ip
11999 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12000 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12001 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12002 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12003 For such case, simply enable this option.
12004 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12005
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012006 * ignore-weight
12007 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12008 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12009 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12010
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012011 * prevent-dup-ip
12012 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12013 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12014 same fqdn.
12015 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12016
12017 Example:
12018 backend b_myapp
12019 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12020 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12021 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12022
12023 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12024 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12025 it
12026 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12027 different address
12028
12029 Default value: not set
12030
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012031resolve-prefer <family>
12032 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12033 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12034 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12035 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12036
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012037 Default value: ipv6
12038
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012039 Example:
12040
12041 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012042
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012043resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012044 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012045 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012046 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012047 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12048 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012049 configured network, another address is selected.
12050
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012051 Example:
12052
12053 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012054
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012055resolvers <id>
12056 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12057 hostname.
12058
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012059 Example:
12060
12061 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012062
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012063 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012064
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012065send-proxy
12066 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12067 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12068 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12069 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012070 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12071 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12072 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12073 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12074 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12075 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12076 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12077 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12078 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12079 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012080 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12081 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012082
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012083send-proxy-v2
12084 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12085 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12086 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12087 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012088 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12089 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12090 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12091 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012092
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012093proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12094 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12095 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012096 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12097 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012098 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12099 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012100 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012101
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012102send-proxy-v2-ssl
12103 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12104 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12105 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12106 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12107 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12108 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12109 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012110 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12111 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012112
12113send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12114 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12115 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12116 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12117 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12118 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12119 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12120 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12121 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012122 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12123 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012125slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012126 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12127 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12128 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12129 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12130 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12131 parameters :
12132
12133 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12134 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12135
12136 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12137 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12138 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12139 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12140
12141 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12142 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12143 seen as failed.
12144
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012145sni <expression>
12146 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12147 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12148 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12149 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012150 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12151 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012152 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012153 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12154 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012155
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012156source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012157source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012158source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012159 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12160 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12161 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12162 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12163
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012164 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12165 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12166 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12167 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12168 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12169 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12170 server.
12171
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012172 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12173 specifying the source address without port(s).
12174
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012175ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012176 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12177 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12178 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12179 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12180 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12181 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012182 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12183 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012184
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012185ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12186 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12187 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12188 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12189
12190ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12191 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12192 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12193 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12194
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012195ssl-reuse
12196 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12197 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12198 default value.
12199 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12200 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12201
12202stick
12203 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12204 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12205 default value.
12206 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12207 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012208
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012209socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012210 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012211 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12212 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12213
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012214tcp-ut <delay>
12215 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12216 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12217 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012218 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012219 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12220 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12221 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12222 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12223 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12224 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12225 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12226 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12227 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12228
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012229tfo
12230 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12231 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12232 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12233 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12234 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012235 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012237track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012238 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12239 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12240 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12241 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012242 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12243
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012244tls-tickets
12245 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12246 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12247 default value.
12248 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12249 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012250
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012251verify [none|required]
12252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012253 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012254 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12255 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012256 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012257 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12258 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12259 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12260 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12261 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12262 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12263 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12264 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012265
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012266verifyhost <hostname>
12267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012268 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12269 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12270 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12271 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12272 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12273 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12274 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12275 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012277weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012278 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12279 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12280 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012281 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12282 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12283 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12284 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12285 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12286 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012287
12288
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122895.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12290-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012291
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012292HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12293using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12294configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012295This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12296can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12297workload.
12298This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12299resolution at run time.
12300Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12301carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12302
12303
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123045.3.1. Global overview
12305----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012306
12307As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12308different steps of the process life:
12309
12310 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12311 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12312 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12313
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012314 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12315 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012316
12317A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12318 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12319 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12320 resolution to know this new IP.
12321
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012322When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012323HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012324SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12325from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12326will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12327will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012328
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012329A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012330 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012331 first valid response.
12332
12333 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12334 servers return an error.
12335
12336
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123375.3.2. The resolvers section
12338----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012339
12340This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012341HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12342contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012343
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012344When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12345uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12346is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12347answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12348
12349When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012350used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012351
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012352 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12353 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12354 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012355
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012356 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12357 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012358
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012359 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12360 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12361 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012362
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012363For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12364following scenarios are possible:
12365
12366 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12367 ignored
12368
12369 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12370 applied
12371
12372 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12373 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12374
12375 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12376 retries the query with a new type
12377
12378 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12379 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012380
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012381As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12382a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012383<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012384
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012385
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012386resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012387 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012388
12389A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12390
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012391accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012392 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012393 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012394 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12395 by RFC 6891)
12396
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012397 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12398
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012399nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12400 DNS server description:
12401 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12402 <ip> : IP address of the server
12403 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12404
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012405parse-resolv-conf
12406 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12407 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12408 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12409
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012410hold <status> <period>
12411 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12412 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012413 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012414 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012415 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12416 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12417 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12418
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012419 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012420
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012421resolve_retries <nb>
12422 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12423 giving up.
12424 Default value: 3
12425
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012426 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12427 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12428 type.
12429
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012430timeout <event> <time>
12431 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12432 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12433 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012434 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12435 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012436 Default value: 1s
12437 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012438 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012439 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012440 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12441 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12442
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012443 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012444
12445 resolvers mydns
12446 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12447 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012448 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012449 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012450 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012451 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012452 hold other 30s
12453 hold refused 30s
12454 hold nx 30s
12455 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012456 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012457 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012458
12459
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124606. Cache
12461---------
12462
12463HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12464(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12465RAM.
12466
12467The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12468this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12469
12470If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12471independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12472when we try to allocate a new one.
12473
12474The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12475
12476It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12477"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12478for more details.
12479
12480When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12481replaced by "<CACHE>".
12482
12483
124846.1. Limitation
12485----------------
12486
12487The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12488
12489- If the response is not a 200
12490- If the response contains a Vary header
12491- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12492- If the response is not cacheable
12493
12494- If the request is not a GET
12495- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12496- If the request contains an Authorization header
12497
12498
124996.2. Setup
12500-----------
12501
12502To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12503the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12504
12505
125066.2.1. Cache section
12507---------------------
12508
12509cache <name>
12510 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12511 size of cache is mandatory.
12512
12513total-max-size <megabytes>
12514 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12515 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12516
12517max-object-size <bytes>
12518 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12519 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12520 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12521
12522max-age <seconds>
12523 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12524 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12525 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12526 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12527 default.
12528
12529
125306.2.2. Proxy section
12531---------------------
12532
12533http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12534 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12535 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12536 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12537 after this one.
12538
12539http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12540 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12541 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12542 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12543 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12544
12545
12546Example:
12547
12548 backend bck1
12549 mode http
12550
12551 http-request cache-use foobar
12552 http-response cache-store foobar
12553 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12554
12555 cache foobar
12556 total-max-size 4
12557 max-age 240
12558
12559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125607. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12561----------------------------------
12562
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012563HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012564client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12565The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12566these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12567but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12568data called patterns.
12569
12570
125717.1. ACL basics
12572---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012573
12574The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12575content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12576from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12577simple :
12578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012579 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012580 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012581 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12582 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012584The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12585adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012586
12587In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012590
12591This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12592Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12593and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012594an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12595conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12596as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12597are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012598
12599ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12600'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12601which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12602
12603There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12604performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012606The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12607specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12608this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012609methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12610ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012611
12612Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12613 - boolean
12614 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12615 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12616 - string
12617 - data block
12618
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012619Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12620converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12621would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12622The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12623which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12624
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012625Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12626keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12627fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12628which are summarized in the table below :
12629
12630 +---------------------+-----------------+
12631 | Sample or converter | Default |
12632 | output type | matching method |
12633 +---------------------+-----------------+
12634 | boolean | bool |
12635 +---------------------+-----------------+
12636 | integer | int |
12637 +---------------------+-----------------+
12638 | ip | ip |
12639 +---------------------+-----------------+
12640 | string | str |
12641 +---------------------+-----------------+
12642 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12643 +---------------------+-----------------+
12644
12645Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12646matching method, see below.
12647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012648The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12649 - boolean
12650 - integer or integer range
12651 - IP address / network
12652 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12653 - regular expression
12654 - hex block
12655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012656The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12657
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012658 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12659 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012660 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012661 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012662 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012663 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012664 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12667read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12668if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12669lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12670will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12671beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12672a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12673lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12674exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12675
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012676The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12677parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12678ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12679a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12680check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12681
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012682The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12683socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12684file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012686Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12687loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12688
12689 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12690
12691In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12692the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12693case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12694as well.
12695
12696The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12697sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12698do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12699methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12700is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012701obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12703default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12704that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12705string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12706
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012707The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12708By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12709string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12710resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12711server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012712waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012713flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12714function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012716There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12717sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12718be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012719
12720 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12721 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12723 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12724 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12725 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012726
12727 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12728 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012729 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012730
12731 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012732 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012733
12734 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012735 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012736
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012737 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012738 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12739
12740 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12741 binary or string samples.
12742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012743 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12744 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012746 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12747 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12748 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012750 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12751 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012753 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12754 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12757 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012759 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12760 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012761 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12764 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12765 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012766
12767For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12768request, it is possible to do :
12769
12770 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12771
12772In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12773buffer, one would use the following acl :
12774
12775 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12776
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012777On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12778possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12779
12780 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012782All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12783criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12784method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12785to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12786criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12787the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012790the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12791For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012793 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12794 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12795 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12796 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012797
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012798
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012799The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12800types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12801combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12802brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12803default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805 +-------------------------------------------------+
12806 | Input sample type |
12807 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012808 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012809 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12810 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012812 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012814 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012816 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012818 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012820 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012822 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012824 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012826 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012828 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012830 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012832 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12834 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012836
12837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128387.1.1. Matching booleans
12839------------------------
12840
12841In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12842Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12843When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12844that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12845
12846Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12847return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12848"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128517.1.2. Matching integers
12852------------------------
12853
12854Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12855enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12856to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12857
12858Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12859matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12860lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012861
12862For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12863unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12864representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12865
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012866As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12867two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12868instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12869ranges and operators.
12870
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012871For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012872operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12873Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12874of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012876Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012877
12878 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12879 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12880 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12881 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12882 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012884For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012885
12886 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12887
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012888This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12889
12890 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128937.1.3. Matching strings
12894-----------------------
12895
12896String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12897different forms :
12898
12899 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012900 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012901
12902 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012903 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012904
12905 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12906 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12907
12908 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12909 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12910
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012911 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12913 matches.
12914
12915 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12916 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12917 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012918
12919String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12920exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12921characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12922string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12923to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012924before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012925
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010012926Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
12927(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
12928Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
12929
12930Example:
12931 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
12932 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
12933
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129357.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12936---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012937
12938Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12939they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12940possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12941passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12942the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012943the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12944match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012945
12946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129477.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12948-------------------------------------
12949
12950It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12951not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12952a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12953to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12954digits may be used upper or lower case.
12955
12956Example :
12957 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12958 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12959
12960
129617.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12962---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012963
12964IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12965netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12966within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012967host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012968difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12969at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12970does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12971parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012972
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012973The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12974abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12975
12976 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12977 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12978 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12979 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12980 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12981 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12982 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12983 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12984
12985Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12986192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12987
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012988IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12989Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12990trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12991IPv6 patterns.
12992
12993HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12994following situations :
12995 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12996 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12997 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12998 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12999 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13000 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13001 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13002 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13003 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13004 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006
130077.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13008----------------------------------
13009
13010Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13011combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13012
13013 - AND (implicit)
13014 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13015 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013017A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013019 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013021Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13022indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13025"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13026requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13027is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13028
13029 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013030 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13031 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13032 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013033
13034To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13035and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13036
13037 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13038 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13039 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13040 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13041
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013042 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013043 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13044 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13045 use_backend www if host_www
13046
13047It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13048expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13049be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13050the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13051
13052 The following rule :
13053
13054 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013055 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056
13057 Can also be written that way :
13058
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013059 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060
13061It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13062to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13063simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13064sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13065good use is the following :
13066
13067 With named ACLs :
13068
13069 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13070 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13071 monitor fail if site_dead
13072
13073 With anonymous ACLs :
13074
13075 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13076
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013077See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13078keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079
13080
130817.3. Fetching samples
13082---------------------
13083
13084Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13085against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13086sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13087ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13088of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13089available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13090
13091This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13092Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13093compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13094deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13095
13096The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13097matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13098method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13099indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13100
13101As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13102when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13103mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13104the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13105ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13106
13107Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13108multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13109when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013110incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13111are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13113all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13114
13115Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13116 - name
13117 - name(arg1)
13118 - name(arg1,arg2)
13119
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013120
131217.3.1. Converters
13122-----------------
13123
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013124Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13125of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13126is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13127was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013128has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013129unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13130
13131These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13132sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13133the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013134support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013135
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013136A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13137support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13138supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13139(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13140bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013142The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013143
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001314451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13145 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13146 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13147 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13148 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13149 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13150
13151 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013152 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13153 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013154 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13155 frontend http-in
13156 bind *:8081
13157 default_backend servers
13158 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13159 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13160
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013161add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013162 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013163 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013164 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13165 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013166 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013167 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13168 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13169 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13170 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013171 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013172 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013173
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013174aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13175 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13176 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13177 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13178 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13179 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13180 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13181
13182 Example:
13183 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13184 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13185
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013186and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013187 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013188 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013189 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13190 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013191 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013192 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13193 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13194 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13195 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013196 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013197 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013198
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013199b64dec
13200 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13201 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13202
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013203base64
13204 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013205 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013206 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13207
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013208bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013209 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013210 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013211 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013212 presence of a flag).
13213
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013214bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13215 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13216 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013217 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013218
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013219concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13220 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13221 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13222 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13223 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13224 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13225 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13226 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13227 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13228 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13229 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013230 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013231 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013232 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013233
13234 Example:
13235 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13236 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13237 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13238 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13239
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013240cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013241 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13242 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013243
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013244crc32([<avalanche>])
13245 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13246 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13247 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13248 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13249 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13250 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13251 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13252 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13253 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13254 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013255 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13256
13257crc32c([<avalanche>])
13258 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13259 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13260 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13261 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13262 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13263 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13264 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13265 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013266
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013267da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013268 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13269 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13270 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13271 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013272 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013273 configuration language.
13274
13275 Example:
13276 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013277 bind *:8881
13278 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013279 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013280
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013281debug
13282 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13283 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13284 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13285
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013286div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013287 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13288 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013289 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013290 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13291 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13294 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13295 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13296 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013297 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013298 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013299
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013300djb2([<avalanche>])
13301 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13302 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13303 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13304 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13305 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13306 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13307 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013308 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13309 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013310
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013311even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013312 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013313 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13314
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013315field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13316 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13317 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13318 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13319 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13320 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13321 fields.
13322
13323 Example :
13324 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13325 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13326 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13327 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13328 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013329
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013330hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013331 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013332 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013333 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013334 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013335
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013336hex2i
13337 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013338 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013339
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013340http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013341 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13342 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013343 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13344 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13345 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13346 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13347 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13348 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13349 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13350 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013352in_table(<table>)
13353 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13354 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13355 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013356 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013357 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13358
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013359ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13360 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013361 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013362 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13363 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13364 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13365 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13366 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013367
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013368json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013369 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013370 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013371 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013372 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13373 of errors:
13374 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13375 bytes, ...)
13376 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13377 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13378
13379 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13380 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13381 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13382 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13383 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13384 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013385 - "ascii" : never fails;
13386 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13387 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013388 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013389 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013390 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13391 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13392
13393 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013394 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013395
13396 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013397 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013398 capture request header user-agent len 150
13399 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013400
13401 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13402 GET / HTTP/1.0
13403 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13404
13405 Output log:
13406 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13407
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013408language(<value>[,<default>])
13409 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13410 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13411 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13412 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13413 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13414 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13415 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13416 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13417 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013418 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013419 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13420 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013421
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013422 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013424 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13425 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013426
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013427 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13428 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13429 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13430 use_backend spanish if es
13431 use_backend french if fr
13432 use_backend english if en
13433 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013434
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013435length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013436 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13437 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13438 type. The result is of type integer.
13439
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013440lower
13441 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13442 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13443 type. The result is of type string.
13444
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013445ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13446 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13447 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13448 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13449 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13450 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13451 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13452
13453 Example :
13454
13455 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013456 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013457 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13458
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013459map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13460map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13461map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13462 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13463 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13464 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13465 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13466 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13467 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13468 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13469 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013471 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13472 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13473 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013474
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013475 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013476 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013478 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13480 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013482 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013484 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13486 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13488 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13490 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13491 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013492 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13493 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13494 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013495 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13496 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13497 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13498 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13499 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013500
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013501 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13502 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13503 the corresponding match text.
13504
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013505 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13506 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13507 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13508 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13509 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013510
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013511 Example :
13512
13513 # this is a comment and is ignored
13514 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13515 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13516 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13517 | | | `---------- value
13518 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13519 | `---------------------------- key
13520 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13521
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013522mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013523 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13524 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013525 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013526 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013527 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013528 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13529 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13530 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13531 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013532 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013533 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013534
13535mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013536 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013537 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13538 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013539 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013540 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013541 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013542 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13543 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13544 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13545 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013546 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013547 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013548
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013549nbsrv
13550 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13551 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13552 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13553 map lookup.
13554
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013555neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013556 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13557 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13558 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13559 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013560
13561not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013562 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013563 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013564 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013565 absence of a flag).
13566
13567odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013568 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013569 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13570
13571or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013572 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013573 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013574 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13575 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013576 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013577 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13578 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13579 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13580 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013581 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013582 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013583
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013584protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13585 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13586 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13587 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13588 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13589 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13590 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13591 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13592 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13593 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13594 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13595 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13596
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013597regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013598 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13599 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13600 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13601 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13602 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13603 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13604 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13605 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13606 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13607 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013608 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13609 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13610 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13611 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013612
13613 Example :
13614
13615 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13616 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13617 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13618 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13619
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013620capture-req(<id>)
13621 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13622 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13623
13624 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013625 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13626 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013627
13628capture-res(<id>)
13629 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13630 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13631
13632 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013633 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13634 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013635
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013636sdbm([<avalanche>])
13637 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13638 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13639 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13640 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13641 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13642 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13643 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013644 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13645 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013646
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013647set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013648 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13649 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13650 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013651 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013652 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13653 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013654 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013655 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13656 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013657 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013658 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013659
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013660sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013661 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013662 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13663
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013664sha2([<bits>])
13665 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13666 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13667
13668 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13669 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13670
13671 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13672 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13673
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013674srv_queue
13675 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13676 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13677 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13678 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13679 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13680
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013681strcmp(<var>)
13682 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13683 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13684 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13685 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13686 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13687 shorter).
13688
13689 Example :
13690
13691 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13692 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13693 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13694
13695
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013696sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013697 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13698 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013699 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013700 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13701 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013702 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013703 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13704 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013705 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013706 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13707 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013708 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013709 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013710
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013711table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13712 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13713 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13714 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13715 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13716 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13717 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13718
13719
13720table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13721 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13722 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13723 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13724 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13725 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13726 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13727
13728table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013731 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013732 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13733 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13734
13735table_conn_cur(<table>)
13736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13739 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13740 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13741
13742table_conn_rate(<table>)
13743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13746 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13747 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13748
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013749table_gpt0(<table>)
13750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13752 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13753 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13754 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13755
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013756table_gpc0(<table>)
13757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13760 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13761 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13762
13763table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13767 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13768 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13769 sample fetch keyword.
13770
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013771table_gpc1(<table>)
13772 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13773 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13774 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13775 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13776 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13777
13778table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13779 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13780 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13781 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13782 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13783 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13784 sample fetch keyword.
13785
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013786table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13787 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13788 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013789 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013790 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13791 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13792
13793table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13796 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13797 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13798 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13799 keyword.
13800
13801table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013804 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013805 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13806 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13807
13808table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13811 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13812 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13813 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13814 keyword.
13815
13816table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13817 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13818 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013819 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013820 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13821 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13822 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13823 keyword.
13824
13825table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13826 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13827 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013828 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013829 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13830 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13831 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13832 keyword.
13833
13834table_server_id(<table>)
13835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13838 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13839 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13840 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13841
13842table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013845 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013846 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13847 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13848 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13849 keyword.
13850
13851table_sess_rate(<table>)
13852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13855 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13856 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13857 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13858 keyword.
13859
13860table_trackers(<table>)
13861 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13862 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13863 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13864 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13865 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13866 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13867 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13868 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13869 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13870 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13871
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013872upper
13873 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13874 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13875 type. The result is of type string.
13876
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013877url_dec
13878 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13879 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13880
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013881ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013882 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013883 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13884 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13885 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013886 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13887 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13888 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13889 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013890 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013891 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13892 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013893
13894 Example:
13895 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13896 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13897
13898 message Point {
13899 int32 latitude = 1;
13900 int32 longitude = 2;
13901 }
13902
13903 message PPoint {
13904 Point point = 59;
13905 }
13906
13907 message Rectangle {
13908 // One corner of the rectangle.
13909 PPoint lo = 48;
13910 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13911 PPoint hi = 49;
13912 }
13913
13914 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13915 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13916 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13917
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013918 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13919 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013920 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013921 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13922
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013923 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013924
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013925 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013926
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013927 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013928 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13929 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13930
13931 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13932 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13933 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13934
13935 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13936 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13937 interpret the previous binary sample.
13938
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013939
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013940unset-var(<var name>)
13941 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13942 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13943 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13944 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13945 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13946 response),
13947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13948 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13949 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13950 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13951
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013952utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13953 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13954 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13955 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13956 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13957 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13958 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13959
13960 Example :
13961
13962 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013963 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013964 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13965
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013966word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13967 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13968 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13969 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13970 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13971 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13972
13973 Example :
13974 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13975 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13976 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13977 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13978 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013979
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013980wt6([<avalanche>])
13981 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13982 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13983 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13984 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13985 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13986 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13987 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013988 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13989 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013990
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013991xor(<value>)
13992 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013993 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013994 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013995 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013996 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013997 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13998 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013999 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014000 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14001 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014002 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014003 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014004
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014005xxh32([<seed>])
14006 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14007 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14008 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14009 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14010 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14011 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14012 as cryptographically secure.
14013
14014xxh64([<seed>])
14015 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14016 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14017 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14018 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14019 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14020 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14021 as cryptographically secure.
14022
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014023
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140247.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025--------------------------------------------
14026
14027A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14028not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14029"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14030The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14031
14032always_false : boolean
14033 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14034 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14035
14036always_true : boolean
14037 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14038 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14039
14040avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014041 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014042 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14043 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14044 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14045 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14046 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14047 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14048 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14049 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14050 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14051 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14052 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14053 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14054 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014057 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14058 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14059 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14060 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014061 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14062
14063be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14064 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14065 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14066 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14067 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14068 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014069 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14070 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014071
14072 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14073 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14074 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014076be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14078 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14079 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014080 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14082 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014083
14084 Example :
14085 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14086 backend dynamic
14087 mode http
14088 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14089 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014091bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014092 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14093 of the string.
14094
14095bool(<bool>) : bool
14096 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14097 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014099connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014101 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14103 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014104
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014105 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014106 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014107 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14108
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014109 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14110 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014111
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014112 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014113 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014114 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014115 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014116 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014118 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014119
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014120 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14121 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014122 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014123 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014124
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014125cpu_calls : integer
14126 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14127 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14128 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14129 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14130 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14131 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14132
14133cpu_ns_avg : integer
14134 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14135 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14136 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14137 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14138 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14139 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14140 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14141 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14142 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14143 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14144 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14145
14146cpu_ns_tot : integer
14147 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14148 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14149 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14150 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14151 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14152 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14153 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14154 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14155 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14156 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14157 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14158 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14159 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14160
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014161date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014162 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014163
14164 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14165 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14166 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014167 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14168
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014169 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14170 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14171 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14172 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14173 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14174
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014175 Example :
14176
14177 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14178 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014179
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014180 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14181 # millisecond granularity
14182 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14183
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014184date_us : integer
14185 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14186 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14187 from the same timeval structure.
14188
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014189distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14190 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14191 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14192 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14193 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14194 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14195 list of supported tokens.
14196
14197distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14198 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14199 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14200 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14201 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14202 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14203 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14204 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14205 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14206 supported tokens.
14207
14208 Example :
14209 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14210 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14211 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14212 # send large files to the big farm
14213 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14214
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014215env(<name>) : string
14216 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14217 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14218 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14219 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14220 certain way.
14221
14222 Examples :
14223 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14224 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14225
14226 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14227 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14230 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014231 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14232 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14234 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014235 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014236 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14237 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014238
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014239fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14240 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14241 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14242 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14246 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14247 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14248 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14249 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14250 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14251 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14252 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014253
14254 Example :
14255 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14256 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14257 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14258 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14259 frontend mail
14260 bind :25
14261 mode tcp
14262 maxconn 100
14263 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14264 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14265 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14266 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014267
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014268hostname : string
14269 Returns the system hostname.
14270
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014271int(<integer>) : signed integer
14272 Returns a signed integer.
14273
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014274ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14275 Returns an ipv4.
14276
14277ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14278 Returns an ipv6.
14279
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014280lat_ns_avg : integer
14281 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14282 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14283 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14284 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14285 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14286 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14287 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14288 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14289 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14290 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14291 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14292 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14293 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14294 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14295
14296lat_ns_tot : integer
14297 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14298 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14299 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14300 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14301 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14302 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14303 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14304 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14305 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14306 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14307 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14308 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14309 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14310 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14311 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14312 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14313 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14314 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14315 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14316
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014317meth(<method>) : method
14318 Returns a method.
14319
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014320nbproc : integer
14321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14322 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14323 and debugging purposes.
14324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14327 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14328 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014329 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14330 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14331 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014332
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014333prio_class : integer
14334 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14335 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14336 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14337
14338prio_offset : integer
14339 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14340 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14341 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14342 set-priority-offset".
14343
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014344proc : integer
14345 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14346 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14347 debugging purposes.
14348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014350 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14351 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14352 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14354 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14355 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14356 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14357 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14358
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014359rand([<range>]) : integer
14360 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14361 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14362 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14363 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14364 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14365
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014366uuid([<version>]) : string
14367 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14368 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14369 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14373 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14374 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14375 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14376 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014377 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14378 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14379
14380srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14382 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14383 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14384 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14385 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14386 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14387 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14388
14389 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14390 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391
14392srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14393 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14394 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14395 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014396 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14398 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14399 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14400
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014401srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14402 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14403 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14404 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14405 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14406 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14407 fetch methods.
14408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014409srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14410 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14411 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014412 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014413 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14414 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014415 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014416 overloading servers).
14417
14418 Example :
14419 # Redirect to a separate back
14420 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14421 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14422 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14423
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014424stopping : boolean
14425 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14426 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14427 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14428
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014429str(<string>) : string
14430 Returns a string.
14431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14433 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14434 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14435
14436table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14437 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14438 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14439 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14440
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014441thread : integer
14442 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14443 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14444 and debugging purposes.
14445
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014446var(<var-name>) : undefined
14447 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014448 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14449 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014450 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014451 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14452 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014453 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014454 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14455 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014456 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014457 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014458
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144597.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460----------------------------------
14461
14462The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14463closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14464methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14465sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14466TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014467the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14468counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014469"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14470used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14471can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14472Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14473table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14474tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14475currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014477bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014478 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14479 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14480 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482be_id : integer
14483 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14484 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14485
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014486be_name : string
14487 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14488 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490dst : ip
14491 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14492 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14493 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14494 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014495 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14496 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14497 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14498 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14499 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14500 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501
14502dst_conn : integer
14503 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14504 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14505 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14506 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14507 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14508 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14509 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14510 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014511
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014512dst_is_local : boolean
14513 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14514 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14515 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14516 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014517 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014518 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14519 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14520 it only once per connection.
14521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014522dst_port : integer
14523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14524 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14525 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14526 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14527 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14528 an HTTP header.
14529
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014530fc_http_major : integer
14531 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14532 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14533 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14534
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014535fc_pp_authority : string
14536 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14537 if any.
14538
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014539fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14540 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14541 header.
14542
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014543fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14544 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14545 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14546 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14547 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14548 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14549 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14550
14551fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14552 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14553 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14554 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14555 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14556 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14557 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14558
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014559fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014560 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14561 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14562 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14563 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14564
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014565fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014566 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14567 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14568 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14569 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14570
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014571fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014572 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14573 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14574 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14575 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14576
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014577fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014578 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14579 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14580 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14581 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14582
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014583fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014584 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14585 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14586 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14587 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14588
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014589fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014590 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14591 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14592 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14593 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14594
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014595fe_defbe : string
14596 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14597 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599fe_id : integer
14600 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014601 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14603
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014604fe_name : string
14605 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14606 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14607 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14608
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014609sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014610sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14611sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14612sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014613 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14614 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14615 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14616
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014617sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014618sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14619sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14620sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014621 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14622 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14623 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14624
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014625sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014626sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14627sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14628sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014629 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14630 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014631 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14632 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14633 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014634
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014635 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014636 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14637 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014638 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14639 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14640 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014641 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14642 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14643
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014644sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14645sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14646sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14647sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14648 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14649 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14650 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14651 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14652 when a first ACL was verified.
14653
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014654sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014655sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14656sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14657sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014658 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014659 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014661sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014662sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14663sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14664sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014665 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14666 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14667 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014669sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014670sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14671sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14672sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014673 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14674 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14675 See also src_conn_rate.
14676
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014677sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014678sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14679sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14680sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014681 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014682 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014683
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014684sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14685sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14686sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14687sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14688 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14689 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14690
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014691sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14692sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14693sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14694sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14695 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14696 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14697
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014698sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014699sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14700sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14701sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014702 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14703 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14704 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014705 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14706 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14707 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014708
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014709sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14710sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14711sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14712sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14713 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14714 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14715 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14716 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14717 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14718 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14719
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014720sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014721sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14722sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14723sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014724 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014725 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14726 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14727
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014728sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014729sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14730sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14731sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014732 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14733 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14734 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14735 src_http_err_rate.
14736
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014737sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014738sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14739sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14740sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014741 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014742 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14743 src_http_req_cnt.
14744
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014745sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014746sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14747sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14748sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014749 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14750 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14751 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14752 src_http_req_rate.
14753
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014754sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014755sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14756sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14757sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014758 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014759 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14760 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14761 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14762 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014763
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014764 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014765 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14766 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014767 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14768
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014769sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14770sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14771sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14772sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14773 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14774 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14775 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14776 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14777 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14778
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014779sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014780sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14781sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14782sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014783 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14784 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14785 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014787sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014788sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14789sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14790sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014791 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14792 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14793 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014794
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014795sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014796sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14797sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14798sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014799 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014800 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14801 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14802 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014803 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014804 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14805
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014806sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014807sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14808sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14809sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014810 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14811 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14812 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14813 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14814 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014815 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014816
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014817sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014818sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14819sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14820sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014821 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14822 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14823 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14824
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014825sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014826sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14827sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14828sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014829 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14830 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014831 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014832 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14833 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14835 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14836 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838so_id : integer
14839 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14840 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14841 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014844 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14846 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14847 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014848 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14849 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14850 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014851 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14852 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14853 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14854 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14855 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14856 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14857 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014858
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014859 Example:
14860 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14861 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014863src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14864 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14865 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14866 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014867 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014869src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14870 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14871 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014872 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014873 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14876 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14877 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14878 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14879 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14880 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14881 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014882
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014883 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014884 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14885 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14886 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14887 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014888 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014889 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14890 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14891
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014892src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14893 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14894 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14895 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14896 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14897 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14898 was verified.
14899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014901 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014903 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014904 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014907 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14909 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014910 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14913 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14914 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14915 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014916 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014919 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014921 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014922 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014923
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014924src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14925 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14926 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14927 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14928 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14929
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014930src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14931 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14932 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14933 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14934 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014937 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014939 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14940 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014941 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14942 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14943 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014944
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014945src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14946 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14947 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14948 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14949 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14950 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14951 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14952 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014955 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014957 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014958 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014959 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14962 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14963 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14964 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14965 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014966 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014970 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14971 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014972 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14975 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14976 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14977 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014978 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014979 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14982 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14983 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14984 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014985 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014986 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14987 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014988
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014989 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014990 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014991 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014992 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014993
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014994src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14995 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14996 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14997 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14998 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14999 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15000 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15001
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015002src_is_local : boolean
15003 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15004 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15005 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15006 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015007 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015008 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15009 once per connection.
15010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015012 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15013 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15014 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15015 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15016 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015018src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015019 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15020 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15021 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15022 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15023 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025src_port : integer
15026 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15027 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15028 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15029 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015032 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015033 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15034 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15035 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015036 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015038src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15039 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15040 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15041 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15042 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015043 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15046 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15047 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15048 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15049 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15050 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15051 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15052 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15053 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015054
15055 Example :
15056 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15057 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15058 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15059 listen ssh
15060 bind :22
15061 mode tcp
15062 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015063 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015065 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015067srv_id : integer
15068 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15069 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15070 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015071
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015072srv_name : string
15073 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15074 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15075 debugging.
15076
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15081closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15082when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15083usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015084future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015085
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001508651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15087 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15088 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15089 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15090 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15091 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15092
15093 Example :
15094 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15095 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15096 # the request.
15097 frontend http-in
15098 bind *:8081
15099 default_backend servers
15100 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15101 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15102
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015103ssl_bc : boolean
15104 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15105 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15106 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15107
15108ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15109 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15110 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15111
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015112ssl_bc_alpn : string
15113 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15114 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015115 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015116 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15117 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15118 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15119 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15120 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15121 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15122
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015123ssl_bc_cipher : string
15124 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15125 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15126
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015127ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15128 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15129 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15130 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15131
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015132ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15133 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15134 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15135 session or a TLS ticket.
15136
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015137ssl_bc_npn : string
15138 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15139 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015140 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015141 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15142 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15143 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15144 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15145 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15146
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015147ssl_bc_protocol : string
15148 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15149 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15150
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015151ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015152 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015153 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15154 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015155
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015156ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15157 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15158 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15159 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15160
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015161ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15162 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15163 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15164 if session was reused or not.
15165
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015166ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15167 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15168 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15169 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15170 BoringSSL.
15171
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015172ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15173 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15174 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15177 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15178 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15179 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15180 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15181 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015183ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15184 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15185 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15186 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15187 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015188
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015189ssl_c_der : binary
15190 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15191 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15192 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015194ssl_c_err : integer
15195 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15196 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15197 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15198 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15199 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15202 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15203 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15204 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15205 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15206 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15207 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15208 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15209 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211ssl_c_key_alg : string
15212 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15213 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15214 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216ssl_c_notafter : string
15217 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15218 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15219 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221ssl_c_notbefore : string
15222 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15223 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15224 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15227 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15228 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15229 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15230 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15231 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15232 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15233 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15234 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236ssl_c_serial : binary
15237 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15238 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15239 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15242 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15243 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15244 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015245 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15246 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15247
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015248 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015249 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15252 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15253 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15254 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256ssl_c_used : boolean
15257 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15258 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260ssl_c_verify : integer
15261 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15262 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15263 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15264 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_c_version : integer
15267 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15268 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015269
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015270ssl_f_der : binary
15271 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15272 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15273 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15276 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15277 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15278 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15279 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015280 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15282 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15283 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285ssl_f_key_alg : string
15286 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15287 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15288 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290ssl_f_notafter : string
15291 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15292 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15293 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295ssl_f_notbefore : string
15296 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15297 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15298 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15301 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15302 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15303 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15304 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15305 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15306 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15307 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15308 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310ssl_f_serial : binary
15311 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15312 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15313 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015314
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015315ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15316 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15317 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15318 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15321 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15322 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15323 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325ssl_f_version : integer
15326 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15327 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15328
15329ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015330 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15331 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15332 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334 Example :
15335 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15336 listen http-https
15337 bind :80
15338 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15339 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15340
15341ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15342 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15343 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15344
15345ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015346 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015347 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15348 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15349 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15350 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15351 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15352 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15353 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15354 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356ssl_fc_cipher : string
15357 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15358 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015359
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015360ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15361 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15362 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015363 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015364
15365ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15366 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15367 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015368 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015369
15370ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15371 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15372 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15373 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015374 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015375 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015376
15377ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15378 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15379 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015380 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015381
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015382ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15383 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15384 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15385 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015387ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015388 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15389 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015390 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15391 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15392 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15393 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015394
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015395ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15396 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15397 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15398 wait until the handshake happened.
15399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15401 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015402 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15403 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015404 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015405 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015406
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015407ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015408 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015409 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15410 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015413 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015414 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15415 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15416 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15417 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15418 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15419 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15420 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422ssl_fc_protocol : string
15423 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15424 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015425
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015426ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015427 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015428 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15429 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015430
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015431ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15432 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15433 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15434 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015436ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15437 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15438 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15439 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15440 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015441
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015442ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15443 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15444 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15445 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15446 BoringSSL.
15447
15448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449ssl_fc_sni : string
15450 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15451 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15452 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15453 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15454 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15455
15456 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15457 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15458 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015459 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015460 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15464 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15467 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15468 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015469
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154717.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15475sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15476only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15477For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15478be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15479can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15480sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15481for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15482content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015485 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15487 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15490 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015491 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015493
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015494req.hdrs : string
15495 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15496 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15497 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15498 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15499
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015500req.hdrs_bin : binary
15501 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15502 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15503 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15504 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15505 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15506 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15507
15508 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15509
15510 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15511 str: <int:length><bytes>
15512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513req.len : integer
15514req_len : integer (deprecated)
15515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15516 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15517 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15518 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15519 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15520 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15521 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15522 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015524req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15525 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015526 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15527 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15528 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15529 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 ACL alternatives :
15532 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15535 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15536 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15537 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15538 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540 ACL alternatives :
15541 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545req.proto_http : boolean
15546req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15547 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15548 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15549 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15550 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15551 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15552 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15553 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 Example:
15556 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15557 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15558 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015559 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15562rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15563 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15564 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15565 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15566 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15567 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15568 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15569 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15572 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15573 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15574 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15575 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15576 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578 ACL derivatives :
15579 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581 Example :
15582 listen tse-farm
15583 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15584 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15585 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15586 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15587 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15588 persist rdp-cookie
15589 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15590 # This is only useful makes sense if
15591 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15592 stick-table type string size 204800
15593 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15594 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15595 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15598 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15601rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15602 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15603 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15604 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15605 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 ACL derivatives :
15608 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015609
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015610req.ssl_alpn : string
15611 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15612 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15613 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15614 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15615 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15616 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015617 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015618
15619 Examples :
15620 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15621 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15622 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015623 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015624 default_backend bk_default
15625
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015626req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15627 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15628 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015629 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15630 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15631 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15632 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15633 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15636req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15637 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15638 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15639 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15640 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15641 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15642 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15643 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645req.ssl_sni : string
15646req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15647 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15648 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15649 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15650 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15651 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15652 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15653 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15654 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15655 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15656 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15657 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15658 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 ACL derivatives :
15661 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663 Examples :
15664 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15665 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15666 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15667 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15668 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015669
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015670req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15671 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15672 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15673 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15674 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15675 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15676 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15677 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15678 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15679 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681req.ssl_ver : integer
15682req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15683 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15684 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15685 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15686 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15687 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15688 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15689 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015690 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 ACL derivatives :
15694 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015695
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015696res.len : integer
15697 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15698 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15699 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15700 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15701 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15702 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15703 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15704 content inspection.
15705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15707 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015708 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15709 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15710 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15711 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15714 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15715 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15716 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15717 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015720
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015721res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15722rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15723 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15724 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15725 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15726 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15727 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15728 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15729 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731wait_end : boolean
15732 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15733 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015734 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015735 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15736 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015737 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15739 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 Examples :
15742 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15743 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15744 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15747 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15748 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15749 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15750 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15751 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15752 tcp-request content reject
15753
15754
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157557.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756--------------------------------------
15757
15758It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15759This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15760data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15761its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15762HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15763content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15764to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15765more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15766response are indexed.
15767
15768base : string
15769 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15770 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15771 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15772 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15773 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15774 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15775 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15776 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15777
15778 ACL derivatives :
15779 base : exact string match
15780 base_beg : prefix match
15781 base_dir : subdir match
15782 base_dom : domain match
15783 base_end : suffix match
15784 base_len : length match
15785 base_reg : regex match
15786 base_sub : substring match
15787
15788base32 : integer
15789 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15790 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15791 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015792 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15793 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15794 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015795
15796base32+src : binary
15797 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15798 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15799 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15800 per-URL counters.
15801
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015802capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15803 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15804 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15805 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15806
15807capture.req.method : string
15808 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15809 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15810 because it's allocated.
15811
15812capture.req.uri : string
15813 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15814 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15815 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15816 allocated.
15817
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015818capture.req.ver : string
15819 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15820 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15821 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15822
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015823capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15824 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15825 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15826 The first entry is an index of 0.
15827 See also: "capture response header"
15828
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015829capture.res.ver : string
15830 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15831 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15832 persistent flag.
15833
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015834req.body : binary
15835 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15836 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15837 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15838 the first chunk is analyzed.
15839
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015840req.body_param([<name>) : string
15841 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15842 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15843 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15844 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15845 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15846 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15847 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15848 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15849 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15850 given.
15851
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015852req.body_len : integer
15853 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15854 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15855 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15856 "option http-buffer-request".
15857
15858req.body_size : integer
15859 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15860 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15861 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15862 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15863 "option http-buffer-request".
15864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865req.cook([<name>]) : string
15866cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15867 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15868 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15869 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15870 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15871 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15872 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15873 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15874 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15875
15876 ACL derivatives :
15877 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15878 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15879 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15880 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15881 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15882 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15883 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15884 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15887cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15888 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15889 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15892cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15893 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15894 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15895 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15896 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15899 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15900 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15901 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15902 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015903 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15905 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15906 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15907 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15910 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15911 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15912 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15913 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015914 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15917 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15918 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15919 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15920 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15921 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15922 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15923 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15924 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15927 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15928 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15929 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15930 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15933 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15934 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15935 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15936 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15937 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15938 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15939 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15940 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015941 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015943 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945 ACL derivatives :
15946 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15947 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15948 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15949 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15950 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15951 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15952 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15953 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15954
15955req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15956hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15957 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15958 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15959 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15960 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15961 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15962 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15963 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15964 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15965 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15966
15967req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15968hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15969 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15970 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15971 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15972 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15973 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015974 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15976 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15977
15978req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15979hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15980 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15981 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15982 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15983 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15984 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15985 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15986 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15987
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015988
15989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15991 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15992 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15993 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15994 basic auth is supported.
15995
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015996http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15997 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15998 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15999 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16000 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16002 basic auth is supported.
16003
16004 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016005 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16006 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16007 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16008 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016010http_auth_pass : string
16011 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16012 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16013 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16014
16015http_auth_type : string
16016 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16017 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16018 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16019
16020http_auth_user : string
16021 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16022 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16023 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016026 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16027 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16029 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031method : integer + string
16032 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16033 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16034 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16035 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16036 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16037 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16038 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040 ACL derivatives :
16041 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043 Example :
16044 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16045 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16046 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016048path : string
16049 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16050 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16051 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16052 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16053 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016054 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016055 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057 ACL derivatives :
16058 path : exact string match
16059 path_beg : prefix match
16060 path_dir : subdir match
16061 path_dom : domain match
16062 path_end : suffix match
16063 path_len : length match
16064 path_reg : regex match
16065 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016066
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016067query : string
16068 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16069 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16070 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16071 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016072 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016073 which stops before the question mark.
16074
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016075req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16076 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16077 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16078 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16079 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081req.ver : string
16082req_ver : string (deprecated)
16083 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16084 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16085 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087 ACL derivatives :
16088 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090res.comp : boolean
16091 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16092 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16093 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095res.comp_algo : string
16096 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16097 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16098 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100res.cook([<name>]) : string
16101scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16102 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16103 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16104 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106 ACL derivatives :
16107 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16110scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16111 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16112 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16113 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16116scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16117 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16118 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16119 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16122 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16123 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16124 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16125 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16126 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16127 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16128 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16129 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16130 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16133 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16134 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16135 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16136 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16137 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16140shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16141 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16142 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16143 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16144 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16145 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16146 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16147 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16148 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150 ACL derivatives :
16151 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16152 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16153 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16154 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16155 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16156 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16157 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16158 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16159
16160res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16161shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16162 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16163 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16164 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16165 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16166 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16169shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16170 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16171 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16172 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16173 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16174 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16175 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016176
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016177res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16178 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16179 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16180 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16181 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16184shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16185 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16186 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16187 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16188 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16189 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16190 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192res.ver : string
16193resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16194 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16195 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197 ACL derivatives :
16198 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16201 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16202 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016203 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16207 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209status : integer
16210 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16211 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16212 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016213
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016214unique-id : string
16215 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16216 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16217 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16218 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16219 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16220 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222url : string
16223 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16224 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16225 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16226 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16227 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16228 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16229 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231 ACL derivatives :
16232 url : exact string match
16233 url_beg : prefix match
16234 url_dir : subdir match
16235 url_dom : domain match
16236 url_end : suffix match
16237 url_len : length match
16238 url_reg : regex match
16239 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016241url_ip : ip
16242 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16243 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16244 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16245 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16246 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16247 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16248 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250url_port : integer
16251 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16252 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16253 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16254 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016255
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016256urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16257url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16259 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016260 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16261 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16262 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16263 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016264 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16265 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016266 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16267 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016269 ACL derivatives :
16270 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16271 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16272 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16273 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16274 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16275 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16276 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16277 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016278
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280 Example :
16281 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16282 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16283 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16284 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016285
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016286urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016287 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16288 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16289 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016290
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016291url32 : integer
16292 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16293 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16294 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16295 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16296 is an unsigned integer.
16297
16298url32+src : binary
16299 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16300 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16301 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16302
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163047.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016305---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016307Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16308every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016309order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016311ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16312---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016313FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016314HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016315HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16316HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016317HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16318HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16319HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16320HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16321LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016322METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016323METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016324METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16325METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16326METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16327METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016328METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016329METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016330RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016331REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016332TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016333WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16334---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016335
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163378. Logging
16338----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016340One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16341provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16342very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16343provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16344state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016345to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346headers.
16347
16348In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16349about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16350send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16351
16352 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16353 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16354 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16355 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16356 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016357 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016358 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016359
16360The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16361allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16362as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16363while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16364real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16365delay.
16366
16367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163688.1. Log levels
16369---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016370
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016371TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016372source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016373HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16374in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16375track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16376syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16377about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016378
16379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163808.2. Log formats
16381----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016382
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016383HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016384and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16385slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16386options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016387
16388 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16389 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16390 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16391 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16392 extents.
16393
16394 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16395 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16396 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16397 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16398 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16399
16400 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16401 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16402 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16403 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16404 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16405
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016406 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16407 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16408 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16409 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16410
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016411 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16412
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016413Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16414specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16415field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16416servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16417always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16418identifier.
16419
16420Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16421 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16422 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16423 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16424 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16425
16426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164278.2.1. Default log format
16428-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016429
16430This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16431as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16432format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16433
16434 Example :
16435 listen www
16436 mode http
16437 log global
16438 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16439
16440 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16441 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16442 (www/HTTP)
16443
16444 Field Format Extract from the example above
16445 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16446 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16447 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16448 4 'to' to
16449 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16450 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16451
16452Detailed fields description :
16453 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16454 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16455 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16456 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16457 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16458 and processed the connection.
16459 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16460
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016461In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16462"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16463connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16464
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016465It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16466will eventually disappear.
16467
16468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164698.2.2. TCP log format
16470---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016471
16472The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16473is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16474information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16475counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16476emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16477environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16478the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16479sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016480specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16481not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16482fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16483marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016484
16485 Example :
16486 frontend fnt
16487 mode tcp
16488 option tcplog
16489 log global
16490 default_backend bck
16491
16492 backend bck
16493 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16494
16495 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16496 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16497 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16498
16499 Field Format Extract from the example above
16500 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16501 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16502 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16503 4 frontend_name fnt
16504 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16505 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16506 7 bytes_read* 212
16507 8 termination_state --
16508 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16509 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16510
16511Detailed fields description :
16512 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016513 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16514 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16515 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016516 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016517 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016518 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016519
16520 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016521 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16522 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16523 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016524
16525 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16526 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16527 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016528 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16529 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16530 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16531 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016532
16533 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16534 and processed the connection.
16535
16536 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16537 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16538 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16539 applications.
16540
16541 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16542 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16543 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16544 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16545 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16546
16547 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16548 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16549 See "Timers" below for more details.
16550
16551 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16552 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16553 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16554 "Timers" below for more details.
16555
16556 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016557 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016558 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16559 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16560 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16561 details.
16562
16563 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16564 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16565 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16566 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16567 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16568
16569 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16570 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16571 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16572 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16573 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16574 for more details.
16575
16576 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016577 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16579 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16580 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016581 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016582
16583 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16584 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16585 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16586 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16587 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16588 caused by a denial of service attack.
16589
16590 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16591 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16592 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16593 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16594 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16595 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16596 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16597 denial of service attack.
16598
16599 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16600 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16601 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16602 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16603 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16604 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16605 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16606 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16607 be processed than on other servers.
16608
16609 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16610 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16611 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16612 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16613 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16614 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16615 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16616 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16617 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16618 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16619 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16620 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16621 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16622
16623 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16624 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16625 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16626 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16627 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16628 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016629 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016630 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16631
16632 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16633 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16634 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16635 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16636 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16637 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016638 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016639 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16640 occurs.
16641
16642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166438.2.3. HTTP log format
16644----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016645
16646The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16647is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16648the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16649are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16650emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16651generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16652"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16653which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016654frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16655is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016656
16657Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16658slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16659with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16660
16661 Example :
16662 frontend http-in
16663 mode http
16664 option httplog
16665 log global
16666 default_backend bck
16667
16668 backend static
16669 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16670
16671 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16672 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16673 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016674 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016675
16676 Field Format Extract from the example above
16677 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16678 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016679 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016680 4 frontend_name http-in
16681 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016682 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016683 7 status_code 200
16684 8 bytes_read* 2750
16685 9 captured_request_cookie -
16686 10 captured_response_cookie -
16687 11 termination_state ----
16688 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16689 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16690 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16691 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16692 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016693
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016694Detailed fields description :
16695 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016696 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16697 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16698 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016699 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016700 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016701 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016702
16703 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016704 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16705 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16706 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016707
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016708 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16709 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016710
16711 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16712 and processed the connection.
16713
16714 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16715 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16716 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16717
16718 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16719 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16720 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16721 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16722 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16723 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16724
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016725 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16726 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16727 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016728 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016729 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16730 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016731 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16732 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016733
16734 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16735 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016736 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016737
16738 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16739 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016740 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16741 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016742
16743 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16744 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16745 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16746 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16747 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016748 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16749 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016750
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016751 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16752 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16753 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16754 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16755 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16756 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16757 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016758 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016759
16760 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16761 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16762 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16763
16764 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16765 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016766 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016767 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16768 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16769 overflowing.
16770
16771 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16772 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16773 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16774 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16775 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16776 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16777 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16778 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16779
16780 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16781 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16782 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16783 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16784 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16785 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16786 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16787 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16788
16789 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16790 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16791 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16792 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16793 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16794 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16795 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16796
16797 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016798 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016799 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16800 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16801 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016802 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016803 system.
16804
16805 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16806 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16807 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16808 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16809 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16810 caused by a denial of service attack.
16811
16812 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16813 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16814 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16815 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16816 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16817 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16818 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16819 denial of service attack.
16820
16821 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16822 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16823 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16824 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16825 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16826 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16827 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16828 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16829 processed than on other servers.
16830
16831 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16832 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16833 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16834 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16835 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16836 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16837 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16838 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16839 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16840 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16841 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16842 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16843 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16844
16845 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16846 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16847 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16848 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16849 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16850 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016851 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016852 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16853
16854 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16855 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16856 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16857 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16858 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16859 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016860 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016861 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16862 occurs.
16863
16864 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16865 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16866 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16867 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16868 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16869 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16870 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16871 cookies" below for more details.
16872
16873 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16874 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16875 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16876 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16877 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16878 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16879 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16880 and cookies" below for more details.
16881
16882 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16883 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16884 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16885 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16886 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16887 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16888 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16889 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16890
16891
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168928.2.4. Custom log format
16893------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016894
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016895The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016896mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016897
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016898HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016899Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16900separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16901prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16902
16903Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16904variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016905("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016906
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016907If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016908as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016909less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16910the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16911
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016912Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016913In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016914in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016915
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016916Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16917'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16918https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16919such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16920
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016921Flags are :
16922 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016923 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016924 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16925 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016926
16927 Example:
16928
16929 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16930 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16931
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016932 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16933
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016934At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16935
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016936 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16937 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016938
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016939the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016940
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016941 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16942 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16943 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016944
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016945and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16946
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016947 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16948 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016949
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016950Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16951
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016952 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016953 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016954 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16955 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16956 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016957 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16958 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16959 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016960 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016961 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16962 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016963 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016964 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16965 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016966 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016967 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016968 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016969 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016970 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016971 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016972 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016973 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16974 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16975 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16976 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16977 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016978 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016979 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16980 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016981 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016982 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16983 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016984 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16985 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16986 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016987 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016988 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16989 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016990 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016991 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16992 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16993 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016994 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016995 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016996 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16997 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16998 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16999 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017000 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017001 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017002 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017003 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017004 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017005 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017006 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17007 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17008 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017009 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017010 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17011 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017012 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017013 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17014 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017015 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017016 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017017 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017018 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017019
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017020 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017021
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017022
170238.2.5. Error log format
17024-----------------------
17025
17026When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17027protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17028By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17029"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017030will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017031logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17032
17033The format looks like this :
17034
17035 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17036 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17037 Connection error during SSL handshake
17038
17039 Field Format Extract from the example above
17040 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17041 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17042 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17043 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17044 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17045
17046These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17047failures.
17048
17049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170508.3. Advanced logging options
17051-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017052
17053Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17054just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17055options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17056for more information about their usage.
17057
17058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170598.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17060------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017061
17062It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17063haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17064commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17065monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17066ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17067
17068 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17069 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17070 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17071 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17072
17073 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17074 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17075 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017076 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017077 such as other load-balancers.
17078
17079 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17080 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17081 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17082
17083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17085----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017086
17087The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17088what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17089or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017090"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017091just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17092log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17093after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17094is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17095with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17096with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17097
17098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170998.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17100------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017101
17102Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17103for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17104"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17105retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17106raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17107a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17108file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17109you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17110"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17111
17112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171138.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17114--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017115
17116Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17117multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17118them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17119"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17120logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17121error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17122and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17123too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17124useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17125alternative.
17126
17127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171288.4. Timing events
17129------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017130
17131Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17132reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17133the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17134frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017135mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17136addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17137
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017138Timings events in HTTP mode:
17139
17140 first request 2nd request
17141 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17142 t tr t tr ...
17143 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17144 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17145 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17146 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17147 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17148
17149Timings events in TCP mode:
17150
17151 TCP session
17152 |<----------------->|
17153 t t
17154 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17155 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17156 |<------ Tt ------->|
17157
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017158 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017159 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017160 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17161 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17162 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017163 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017164 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17165 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17166 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17167 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017168
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017169 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17170 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17171 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017172 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17173 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17174 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17175 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17176 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17177 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017178
17179 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17180 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17181 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17182 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17183 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17184 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17185 request typed by hand during a test.
17186
17187 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17188 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017189 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017190 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17191 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17192 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17193 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017194
17195 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17196 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17197 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17198 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17199 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17200
17201 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17202 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17203 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17204 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17205 connection never established.
17206
17207 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17208 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17209 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17210 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17211 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17212 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17213 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17214 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17215 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17216 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17217 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17218
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017219 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17220 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17221 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17222 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17223 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17224 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17225
17226 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17227
17228 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17229 "Ta" can never be negative.
17230
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017231 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17232 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017233 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17234 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017235 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017236
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017237 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017238
17239 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017240 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17241 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017242
17243These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17244protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17245that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017246due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17247"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17248that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249
17250Most common cases :
17251
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017252 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17253 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17254 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17255 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17256 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17257 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17258 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17259 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17260 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17261 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17262 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017263 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017264
17265 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17266 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17267 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17268 of ms on remote networks.
17269
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017270 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17271 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17272 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017274 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17275 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17276 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17277 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17278 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17279 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17280 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17281 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17282 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017283
17284Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17285
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017286 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017287 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017288 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017290 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017291 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17292 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17293
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017294 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17296 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17297 flags.
17298
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017299 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17300 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017301 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17302 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17303 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17304 the client connection was maintained open.
17305
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017306 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017307 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017308 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017309 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17310
17311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173128.5. Session state at disconnection
17313-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017314
17315TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17316"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173172-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17318each of which has a special meaning :
17319
17320 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17321 session to terminate :
17322
17323 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17324
17325 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17326 server explicitly refused it.
17327
17328 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17329 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17330 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17331 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017332 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017333
17334 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17335 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336
17337 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17338 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17339 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17340 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17341 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17342
17343 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17344 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17345 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17346 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17347 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17348
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017349 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17350 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17351
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017352 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17353 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17354 backup connections when going up.
17355
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017356 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17357
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17359 send or receive data.
17360
17361 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17362 send or receive data.
17363
17364 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17365 with nothing left in the buffers.
17366
17367 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17368
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017369 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017370 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17371
17372 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17373 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17374 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17375 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17376 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17377
17378 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17379 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17380
17381 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17382 server (HTTP only).
17383
17384 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17385
17386 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17387 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17388 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17389
17390 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17391 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17392 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17393
17394 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17395
17396 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17397 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17398
17399 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17400 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17401 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17402
17403 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17404 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017405 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17406 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017407
17408 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17409 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17410 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17411 another server.
17412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017413 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414 server.
17415
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017416 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17417 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17418 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17419 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17420
17421 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17422 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17423 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17424 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17425
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017426 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17427 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17428 "use-server" rule).
17429
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17431
17432 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17433 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17434
17435 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17436
17437 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17438 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17439 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17440
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017441 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17442 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017443 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017444 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17445 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17446
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017447 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17448
17449 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17450 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17451
17452 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17453
17454 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17455
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017456The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17457was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017458helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17459starvation, attacks, etc...
17460
17461The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17462alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17463easier finding and understanding.
17464
17465 Flags Reason
17466
17467 -- Normal termination.
17468
17469 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17470 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17471 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17472 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17473
17474 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17475 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17476 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17477 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17478 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17479 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017480
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017481 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17482 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017483 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017484
17485 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17486 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17487 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17488
17489 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17490 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17491 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17492 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17493 the server takes too long to respond.
17494
17495 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17496 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17497 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17498 long a time to respond.
17499
17500 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17501 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17502 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17503 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017504 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17505 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017506
17507 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17508 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17509 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17510 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17511 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017512 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017513 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17514 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17515 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17516 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17517 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17518 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17519 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17520 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017521 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017522 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17523 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17524 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017525
17526 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17527 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017528 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17529 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17530 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17531 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017533 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17534 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017536 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017537 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17538 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017539 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017540 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17541 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17542
17543 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17544 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17545 503 or 504 here.
17546
17547 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17548 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17549 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17550 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17551 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17552
17553 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17554 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017555 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017556 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17557 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17558
17559 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17560 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17561 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17562 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17563 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17564 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17565 between haproxy and the server.
17566
17567 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17568 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17569 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17570 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17571 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17572 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17573 solution is to fix the application.
17574
17575 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17576 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17577 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17578 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17579 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17580 external attacks.
17581
17582 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17583 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017584 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017585 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17586 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17587
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017588 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17589 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17590 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017591 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017592 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017593
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017594 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17595 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17596 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17597 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017598 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17599 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17600 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17601 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17602 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017603
17604 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17605 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17606 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17607 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17608
17609 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17610 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17611 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17612 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17613
17614 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17615 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17616 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17617 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017619The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17620persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17621important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17622re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17623
17624 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17625
17626 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17627 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17628 set on a GET request.
17629
17630 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17631 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017632 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017633 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17634
17635 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17636 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17637 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17638
17639 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17640 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17641 already got a cookie.
17642
17643 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17644 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17645 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17646 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17647 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17648
17649 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17650 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17651 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17652
17653 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17654 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17655 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17656
17657 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17658 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17659
17660 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17661 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17662 then advertised in the response.
17663
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176658.6. Non-printable characters
17666-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017667
17668In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17669consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17670converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17671prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17672being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17673escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17674is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17675'}' when logging headers.
17676
17677Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17678issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17679containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17680
17681Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17682the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17683performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17684
17685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17687---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017688
17689Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17690achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017691section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017692cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17693the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17694the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017695locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017696not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17697user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17698a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17699wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17700
17701 Examples :
17702 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17703 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17704
17705 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17706 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17707
17708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177098.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17710---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711
17712Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17713proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17714the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17715server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17716
17717Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17718response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017719section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017720
17721It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017722time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17723appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017724are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17725and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17726follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17727request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17728in the logs.
17729
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017730As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17731frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17732an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017734 Example :
17735 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17736 listen proxy-out
17737 mode http
17738 option httplog
17739 option logasap
17740 log global
17741 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17742
17743 # log the name of the virtual server
17744 capture request header Host len 20
17745
17746 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17747 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17748
17749 # log the beginning of the referrer
17750 capture request header Referer len 20
17751
17752 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17753 capture response header Server len 20
17754
17755 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17756 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17757
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017758 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017759 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17760
17761 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17762 capture response header Via len 20
17763
17764 # log the URL location during a redirection
17765 capture response header Location len 20
17766
17767 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17768 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17769 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17770 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17771 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17772
17773 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17774 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17775 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17776 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017777 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017778
17779 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17780 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17781 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17782 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17783 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017784 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017785
17786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177878.9. Examples of logs
17788---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017789
17790These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17791them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17792reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17793
17794 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17795 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17796 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17797
17798 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17799 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17800
17801 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17802 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17803 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17804
17805 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17806 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17807
17808 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17809 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17810 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17811
17812 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017813 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017814 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17815 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17816
17817 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17818 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17819 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17820
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017821 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17822 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17823 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17824 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17825 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17826 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017827
17828 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017829 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017830
17831 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17832 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17833 Nothing was sent to any server.
17834
17835 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17836 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17837
17838 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17839 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017840 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841 send a 408 return code to the client.
17842
17843 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17844 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17845
17846 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17847 5 seconds ("c----").
17848
17849 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17850 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017851 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017852
17853 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017854 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017855 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17856 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17857 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17858 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17859 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017860
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017861
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178629. Supported filters
17863--------------------
17864
17865Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17866accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17867unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17868
17869See also : "filter"
17870
178719.1. Trace
17872----------
17873
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017874filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017875
17876 Arguments:
17877 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17878 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17879
17880 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17881 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17882 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17883 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17884
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017885 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017886 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17887 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17888 amount of the parsed data.
17889
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017890 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017891
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017892This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17893callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17894information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17895filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17896
17897Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17898tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17899a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17900
17901
179029.2. HTTP compression
17903---------------------
17904
17905filter compression
17906
17907The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17908keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017909when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17910fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17911done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17912explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17913filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17914listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17915order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017916
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017917See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17918 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017919
17920
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17922--------------------------------------------
17923
17924filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17925
17926 Arguments :
17927
17928 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17929 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17930 parsed.
17931
17932 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17933 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17934 part must be placed in its own scope.
17935
17936The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17937external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017938streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017939exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17940also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17941
17942SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17943the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17944
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017945For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017946"doc/SPOE.txt".
17947
17948Important note:
17949 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17950 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17951
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179529.4. Cache
17953----------
17954
17955filter cache <name>
17956
17957 Arguments :
17958
17959 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17960
17961The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17962"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017963cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017964other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17965case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17966is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17967filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017968listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17969order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017970
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017971See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17972 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17973
17974
179759.5. Fcgi-app
17976-------------
17977
17978filter fcg-app <name>
17979
17980 Arguments :
17981
17982 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17983
17984The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17985request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17986reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17987used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17988implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17989used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17990fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17991used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17992order.
17993
17994See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
17995 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
17996
17997
1799810. FastCGI applications
17999-------------------------
18000
18001HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18002feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18003the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18004FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18005servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18006FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18007backend.
18008
18009HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18010application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18011connection.
18012
1801310.1. Setup
18014-----------
18015
1801610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18017--------------------------
18018
18019fcgi-app <name>
18020 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18021 document root must be defined.
18022
18023acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18024 Declare or complete an access list.
18025
18026 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18027 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18028 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18029 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18030 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18031
18032docroot <path>
18033 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18034 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18035 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18036
18037index <script-name>
18038 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18039 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18040 is an optional setting.
18041
18042 Example :
18043 index index.php
18044
18045log-stderr global
18046log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18047 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18048 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18049
18050 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18051 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18052
18053pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18054 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18055 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18056 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18057
18058 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18059 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18060 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18061 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18062
18063 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18064 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18065
18066path-info <regex>
18067 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18068 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18069 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18070 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18071 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18072
18073 Example :
18074 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18075
18076option get-values
18077no option get-values
18078 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18079
18080 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18081 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18082
18083 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18084 application will accept.
18085
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018086 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18087 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018088
18089 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18090 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18091 option is disabled.
18092
18093 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18094 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18095 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18096 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18097 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18098 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18099
18100option keep-conn
18101no option keep-conn
18102 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18103 sending a response.
18104
18105 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18106 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18107
18108option max-reqs <reqs>
18109 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18110 accept.
18111
18112 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18113 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18114 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18115 to 1.
18116
18117option mpxs-conns
18118no option mpxs-conns
18119 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18120
18121 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18122 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18123
18124set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18125 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18126 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18127 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18128 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18129
18130 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18131 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18132 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18133
18134 Example :
18135 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18136 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18137
18138 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18139
18140
1814110.1.2. Proxy section
18142---------------------
18143
18144use-fcgi-app <name>
18145 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18146
18147 Arguments :
18148 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18149
18150 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18151 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18152 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18153 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18154 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18155
18156 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18157 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18158 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18159 application are evaluated.
18160
18161
1816210.1.3. Example
18163---------------
18164
18165 frontend front-http
18166 mode http
18167 bind *:80
18168 bind *:
18169
18170 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18171 default_backend back-static
18172
18173 backend back-static
18174 mode http
18175 server www A.B.C.D:80
18176
18177 backend back-dynamic
18178 mode http
18179 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18180 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18181
18182 fcgi-app php-fpm
18183 log-stderr global
18184 option keep-conn
18185
18186 docroot /var/www/my-app
18187 index index.php
18188 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18189
18190
1819110.2. Default parameters
18192------------------------
18193
18194A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18195the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18196scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18197applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18198
18199 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18200 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18201 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18202 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18203 | | |
18204 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18205 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18206 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18207 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18208 | | application. |
18209 | | |
18210 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18211 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18212 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18213 | | |
18214 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18215 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18216 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18217 | | the application's configuration. |
18218 | | |
18219 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18220 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18221 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18222 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18223 | | |
18224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18225 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18226 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18227 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18228 | | be defined. |
18229 | | |
18230 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18231 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18232 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18233 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18234 | | is not set too. |
18235 | | |
18236 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18237 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18238 | | set. |
18239 | | |
18240 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18241 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18242 | | the request. |
18243 | | |
18244 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18245 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18246 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18247 | | |
18248 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18249 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18250 | | script to process the request. |
18251 | | |
18252 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18253 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18254 | | |
18255 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18256 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18257 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18258 | | |
18259 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18260 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18261 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18262 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18263 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18264 | | |
18265 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18266 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18267 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18268 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18269 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18270 | | side. |
18271 | | |
18272 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18273 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18274 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18275 | | connected to. |
18276 | | |
18277 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18278 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18279 | | |
18280 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18281 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18282 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18283 | | |
18284 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18285
18286
1828710.3. Limitations
18288------------------
18289
18290The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18291way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18292during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18293establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18294application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18295or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18296message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18297these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18298and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18299
18300Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18301request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18302requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18303
18304About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18305into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18306fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18307"http-request" ones.
18308
18309Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18310FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18311processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18312must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18313here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018315/*
18316 * Local variables:
18317 * fill-column: 79
18318 * End:
18319 */